blob: 4d413be5f2e04e3ffa1eb60ce45c22601ccc8707 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9d58c9b2020-10-17 10:31:50 +02007 2020/10/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
479list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
480arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
481before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
483 Example:
484
485 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
486
487 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
488
489 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
492file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
495 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
496
497* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
498 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
499 directory.
500
501* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 processes, separated by semicolons.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 CLI, separated by semicolons.
508
509See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200510
5112.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200512----------------
513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100514Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100515values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
516otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
517numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
518for every keyword. Supported units are :
519
520 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
521 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
522 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
523 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
524 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
525 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
526
527
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005282.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200529-------------
530
531 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
532 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
533 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
534 global
535 daemon
536 maxconn 256
537
538 defaults
539 mode http
540 timeout connect 5000ms
541 timeout client 50000ms
542 timeout server 50000ms
543
544 frontend http-in
545 bind *:80
546 default_backend servers
547
548 backend servers
549 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
550
551
552 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
553 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
554 global
555 daemon
556 maxconn 256
557
558 defaults
559 mode http
560 timeout connect 5000ms
561 timeout client 50000ms
562 timeout server 50000ms
563
564 listen http-in
565 bind *:80
566 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
567
568
569Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
570
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100571 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200572
573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005743. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575--------------------
576
577Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
578are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
579of them have command-line equivalents.
580
581The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
582
583 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200584 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - description
590 - deviceatlas-json-file
591 - deviceatlas-log-level
592 - deviceatlas-separator
593 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900594 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - gid
596 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100597 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200598 - h1-case-adjust
599 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100600 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100601 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100602 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200603 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200614 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200675 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200682 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100683 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100685 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.session-timeout
687 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200688 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100689 - tune.maxaccept
690 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200691 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200692 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200693 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200694 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
695 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200700 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100701 - tune.sndbuf.client
702 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100703 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200704 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100705 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200706 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100707 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200708 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200709 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100710 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200711 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100712 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200713 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
714 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
715 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100716 - tune.zlib.memlevel
717 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100718
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200721 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725------------------------------------
726
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727ca-base <dir>
728 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100729 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
730 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
731 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733chroot <jail dir>
734 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
735 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
736 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
737 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
738 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100740
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
742 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
743 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
744 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
745 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
746 set. These sets have the format
747
748 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
749
750 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
753 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100754 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
755 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100756 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100757 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100759 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
761 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
762 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
763 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100764
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100765 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
766 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
767 on the machine's word size.
768
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100770 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
771 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
772 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
773 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
774 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
775 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776
777 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
779
780 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
781 # first 4 CPUs
782
783 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
784 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
785 # word size.
786
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
792
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100793 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
794 # and so on.
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100800 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
801 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
802 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
803
804 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
805 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
807
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100808 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
809 # and a thread range.
810 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
811 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
813
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814crt-base <dir>
815 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100816 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
817 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819daemon
820 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
821 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100822 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
823 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825deviceatlas-json-file <path>
826 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828
829deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200831 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
832
833deviceatlas-separator <char>
834 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
835 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
836
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100837deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200838 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
839 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
840 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100841
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900842external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100843 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
844 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100845 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
846 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
847 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
848 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
849 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851gid <number>
852 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
853 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
854 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100855 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
856 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100858
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100859group <group name>
860 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
861 See also "gid" and "user".
862
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100863hard-stop-after <time>
864 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
865
866 Arguments :
867 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
868 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
869 SIGUSR1 signal.
870
871 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
872 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
873 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
874
875 Example:
876 global
877 hard-stop-after 30s
878
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200879h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
880 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
881 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
882 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
883 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500884 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200885 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
886 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
887 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
888 specified in a proxy.
889
890 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
891 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
892 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
893 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
894 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
895 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
896 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
897
898 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
899 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
900 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
901 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
902 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
903
904 Example:
905 global
906 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
907
908 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
909 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
910
911h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
912 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
913 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
914 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
915 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
916 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
917 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
918 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
919 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
920
921 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
922 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
923 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
924
925 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
926 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
927
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100928insecure-fork-wanted
929 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
930 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
931 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
932 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
933 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
934 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
935 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
936 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
937 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
938 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
939 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
940 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
941 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
942 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
943 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
944 disable it.
945
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100946insecure-setuid-wanted
947 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
948 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
949 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
950 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
951 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
952 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
953 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
954 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
955 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
956 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
957 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
958 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
959 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
960 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
961
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100962issuers-chain-path <dir>
963 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
964 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
965 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
966 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
967 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
968 "issuers-chain-path".
969 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
970 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
971 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
972 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
973 will share the chain in memory.
974
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200975localpeer <name>
976 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
977 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
978 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
979 the configuration parsing.
980
981 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
982 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
983
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200984log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
985 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100986 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 configured with "log global".
989
990 <address> can be one of:
991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100992 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100993 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
994 port).
995
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100996 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
997 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
998 port).
999
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001000 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001001 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1002 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001003 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001004
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001005 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1006 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1007 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1008 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1009 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1010 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1011 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1012 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1013 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1014 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1015 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1016 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1017 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1018 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001019 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1020 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001021
1022 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1023 "fd@2", see above.
1024
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001025 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1026 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1027 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1028 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1029 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1030
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001031 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1032 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001033
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001034 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1035 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1036 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1037 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1038 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1039 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1040 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1041 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1042 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1043 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1045 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001046
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001047 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1048 one of the following :
1049
1050 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1051 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1052
1053 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1055
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001056 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1057 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1058 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1059 designed to be used with a local log server.
1060
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001061 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1062 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1063 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1064 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1065 logger consumes.
1066
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001067 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1068 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1069 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1070 used with a local log server.
1071
1072 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1073 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1074 designed to be used with a local log server.
1075
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001076 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1077 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1078 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1079 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1080
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001081 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1082 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1083 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1084 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1085 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1086
1087 <sample_size>
1088 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1089 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1090 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1091 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1092 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1093
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001094 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001095
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001096 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1097 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1098 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1099
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001100 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1101 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1102 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1103 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104
1105 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001106 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1107 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1108 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1109 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1110 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1111 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001113 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001115log-send-hostname [<string>]
1116 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1117 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1118 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1119 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1120 the logs.
1121
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001122log-tag <string>
1123 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1124 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1125 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001126 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001127
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001128lua-load <file>
1129 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1130 used multiple times.
1131
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001132lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1133 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1134 variable.
1135 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1136 to "path".
1137
1138 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1139 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1140 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1141 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1142 will be checked earlier.
1143
1144 As an example by specifying the following path:
1145
1146 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1147 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1148
1149 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1150 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1151 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1152 paths if that does not exist either.
1153
1154 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1155 documentation.
1156
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001157master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001158 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1159 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1160 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001161 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001162 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1163 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001164 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1165 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1166 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1167 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1168 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001170 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001171
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001172mworker-max-reloads <number>
1173 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001174 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001175 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1176 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1177 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1178
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001179nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1181 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1182 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001183 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1184 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001185 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1186 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1187 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001189nbthread <number>
1190 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001191 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1192 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1193 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1194 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1195 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001196 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1197 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1198 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1199 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1200 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1201 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1202 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001204pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001205 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1206 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1207 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1208 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001209
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001210pp2-never-send-local
1211 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1212 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1213 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1214 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1215 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1216 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1217 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1218 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1219 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1220 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1221 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1222
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001223presetenv <name> <value>
1224 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1225 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1226 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1227 and "unsetenv".
1228
1229resetenv [<name> ...]
1230 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1231 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1232 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1233 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1234 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1235 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1236 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1237 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1238
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001239stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001240 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1241 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1242 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1243 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1244 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1245 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001246 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001247 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1248 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1249 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1250 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001251
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001252server-state-base <directory>
1253 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001254 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1255 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001256
1257server-state-file <file>
1258 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1259 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1260 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1261 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1262 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1263 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1264 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1265 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001266 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1267 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001268
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001269setenv <name> <value>
1270 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1271 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1272 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1273 and "unsetenv".
1274
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001275set-dumpable
1276 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001277 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1278 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1279 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1280 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1281 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1282 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1283 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1284 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1285 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1286 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1287 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1288 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1289 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1290 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1291 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1292 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1293 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001294
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001295ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001298 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001299 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001300 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1301 information and recommendations see e.g.
1302 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1303 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1304 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1305 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001306
1307ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1309 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1310 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1311 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1312 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001313 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1314 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1315 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001316 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001317
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001318ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1320 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1321 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1322 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1323 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1324
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001325ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1327 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1328 keyword to see available options.
1329
1330 Example:
1331 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001332 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001333
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001334ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1336 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001337 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001338 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001339 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1340 information and recommendations see e.g.
1341 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1342 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1343 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1344 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1345 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001346
1347ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1349 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1350 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1351 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1352 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001353 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1354 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1355 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1356 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001357
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001358ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1360 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1361 keyword to see available options.
1362
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001363ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1365 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1366 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001367 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001368 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001369 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1370 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1371 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1372 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001373 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1374 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1375 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1376
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001377ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1378 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1379 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
1380 (ex: with "foobar.pem" load "foobar.pem.key"). With this option enabled,
1381 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
1382 "foobar.pem" load "foobar.key").
1383
1384 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1385 and won't try to remove them.
1386
1387 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1388
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001389ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001390 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001391 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1392 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001393
1394 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1395 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1396 optimize the startup time.
1397
1398 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1399 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1400 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1401
1402 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001403 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001404
1405 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001406 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1407
1408 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1409 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1410 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1411 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1412 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1413 bind configuration..
1414
1415 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1416 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1417 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1418 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1419 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1420 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1421 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1422 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1423
1424 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1425
1426 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1427 a cert bundle.
1428
1429 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1430 separately in several "crt".
1431
1432 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1433 since files are loading separately.
1434
1435 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1436 required to commit them.
1437
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001438 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001439 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001440
1441 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1442
1443 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1444
1445 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1446 not provided in the PEM file.
1447
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001448 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1449 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1450
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001451 The default behavior is "all".
1452
1453 Example:
1454 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1455 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1456 ssl-load-extra-files none
1457
1458 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1459
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001460ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1461 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1462 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1463 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1464
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001465ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001466 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001467 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1468 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1469 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1470 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1471 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1472 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001473 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001474
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001475stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1476 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1477 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1478 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001479 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001480 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001481
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001482 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1483 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1484 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001485
1486stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1487 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1488 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001489 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001490
1491stats maxconn <connections>
1492 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1493 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001495uid <number>
1496 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1497 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1498 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1499 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1500
1501ulimit-n <number>
1502 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1503 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1504 option.
1505
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001506unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1507 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1508
1509 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1510 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1511 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1512 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1513 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1514 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1515 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1516 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1517 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1518 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1519
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001520unsetenv [<name> ...]
1521 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1522 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1523 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1524 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1525 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1526 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1527 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1528
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529user <user name>
1530 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1531 See also "uid" and "group".
1532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001533node <name>
1534 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1535
1536 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1537 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1538 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1539 traffic.
1540
1541description <text>
1542 Add a text that describes the instance.
1543
1544 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1545 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1546 "<" and ">" characters.
1547
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100154851degrees-data-file <file path>
1549 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001551
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001552 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001553 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1554
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000155551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001556 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1557 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1558 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1559
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001560 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001561 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1562
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200156351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001564 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1565 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1566
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001567 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1568 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1569
157051degrees-cache-size <number>
1571 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1572 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1573 By default, this cache is disabled.
1574
1575 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001576 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1577
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001578wurfl-data-file <file path>
1579 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1580 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1581
1582 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1583 with USE_WURFL=1.
1584
1585wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1586 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1587 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1588 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1589
1590 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1591
1592 Valid WURFL properties are:
1593 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1594
1595 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1596 device.
1597
1598 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1599 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1600
1601 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1602 particular web request.
1603
1604 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1605 used Libwurfl API version.
1606
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001607 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1608 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1609
1610 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1611 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1612
1613 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1614
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001615 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1616 with USE_WURFL=1.
1617
1618wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1619 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1620 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1621
1622 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1623 with USE_WURFL=1.
1624
1625wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1626 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1627 thus before the chroot.
1628
1629 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1630 with USE_WURFL=1.
1631
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001632wurfl-cache-size <size>
1633 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1634 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001635 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001636 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001637
1638 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1639 with USE_WURFL=1.
1640
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001641strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001642 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1643 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1644 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1645 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1646 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001649-----------------------
1650
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001651busy-polling
1652 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1653 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1654 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1655 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1656 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1657 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1658 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1659 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1660 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1661 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1662 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1663 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1664 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1665 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1666 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1667 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1668 "poll" pollers.
1669
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001670 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1671 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1672 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1673
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001674max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1675 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1676 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1677 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1678 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1679 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1680 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1681 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1682 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001684maxconn <number>
1685 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1686 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1687 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001688 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1689 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1690 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1691 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001692 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1693 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1694 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1695 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1696 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1697 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001699maxconnrate <number>
1700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1707 fairness.
1708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001709maxcomprate <number>
1710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001711 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001716 default value.
1717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001718maxcompcpuusage <number>
1719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728maxpipes <number>
1729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1735
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001736maxsessrate <number>
1737 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1738 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1739 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1740 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1741 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1742 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1743 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1744 fairness.
1745
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001746maxsslconn <number>
1747 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1748 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1749 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1750 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1751 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1752 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1753 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001754 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1755 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1756 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1757 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1758 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1759 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1760 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001761
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001762maxsslrate <number>
1763 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1764 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1765 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1766 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1767 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1768 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1769 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1770 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1771 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1772 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1773
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001774maxzlibmem <number>
1775 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1776 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1777 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001778 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1779 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1780 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1781
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001782noepoll
1783 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1784 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001785 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001786
1787nokqueue
1788 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1789 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1790 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1791
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001792noevports
1793 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1794 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1795 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1796 also "nopoll".
1797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001798nopoll
1799 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1800 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001802 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1803 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001804
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001805nosplice
1806 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001807 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001808 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001809 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001810 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1811 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1812 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1813 "option splice-response".
1814
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001815nogetaddrinfo
1816 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1817 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1818
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001819noreuseport
1820 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1821 command line argument "-dR".
1822
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001823profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1824 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1825 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1826 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1827 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001828 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001829 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1830 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1831 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1832 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1833
1834 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1835 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1836 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1837 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1838 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001839 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1840 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1841 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1842 CLI.
1843
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001844spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001845 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1846 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1847 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1848 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1849 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1850 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001852ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001853 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001854 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001855 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1856 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1857 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1858 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1859 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1861 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001862 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1863 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1864 openssl configuration file uses:
1865 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1866
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001867ssl-mode-async
1868 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001869 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001870 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1871 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1872 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001873 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001874 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001875
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001876tune.buffers.limit <number>
1877 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1878 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1879 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1880 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1881 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001883 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1884 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1885 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1886 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1887 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1888 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1889 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1890 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1891 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1892
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001893tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1894 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1895 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1896 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1897 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1898
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001899tune.bufsize <number>
1900 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1901 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1902 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1903 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1904 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1905 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1906 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001907 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1908 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1909 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001910 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001911 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1912 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1913 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001914
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001915tune.chksize <number>
1916 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1917 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1918 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1919 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1920 checks whenever possible.
1921
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001922tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1923 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1924 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1925 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1926 this value. The default value is 1.
1927
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001928tune.fail-alloc
1929 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1930 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1931 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1932 gracefully.
1933
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001934tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1935 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1936 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1937 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1938 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1939 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1940
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001941tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1942 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1943 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1944 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1945 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1946 change it.
1947
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001948tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1949 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1951 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001952 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1953 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1954 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1955 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1956 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1957
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001958tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1959 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1960 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1961 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1962 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1963 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1964 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1965 recommended not to change this value.
1966
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001967tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1968 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1969 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1970 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1971 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1972 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1973 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1974 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1975
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001976tune.http.cookielen <number>
1977 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1978 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1979 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1980 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1981 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1982 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1983 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1984 to change this value.
1985
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001986tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001987 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1988 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001989 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001990 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001991 configuration directives too.
1992 The default value is 1024.
1993
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001994tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1995 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1996 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1997 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1998 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1999 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2000 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002001 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2002 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2003 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002004
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002005tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2006 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2007 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2008 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2009 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2010 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2011 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2012 this option to "off". The default is on.
2013
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002014tune.idletimer <timeout>
2015 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2016 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2017 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2018 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2019 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2020 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002021 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002022 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002023 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2024
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002025tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2026 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2027 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2028 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2029 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2030 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2031 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2032 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2033 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2034 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2035
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002036tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2037 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002038 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002039 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2040 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002041 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002042 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2043 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2044
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002045tune.lua.maxmem
2046 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2047 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2048 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2049 memory.
2050
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002051tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2052 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002053 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2054 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002055 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002056
2057tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2058 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2059 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2060 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2061 check servers.
2062
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002063tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2064 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2065 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2066 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002068
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002069tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002070 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2071 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2072 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2073 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2074 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2075 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2076 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2077 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2078 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2079 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002080
2081tune.maxpollevents <number>
2082 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2083 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2084 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2085 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2086 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2087
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002088tune.maxrewrite <number>
2089 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2090 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2091 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2092 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2093 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2094 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2095 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2096 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2097 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2098 bufsize.
2099
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002100tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2101 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2102 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2103 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2104 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2105 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2106 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2107 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2108 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2109 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002110 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2111 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002112 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2113 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2114 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2115 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2116 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2117 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2118 setting this parameter to 0.
2119
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002120tune.pipesize <number>
2121 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2122 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2123 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2124 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2125 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2126 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2127
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002128tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2129 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2130 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2131 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2132 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2133 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2134 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002135 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002136
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002137tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2138 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2139 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2140 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2141 default is 20.
2142
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002143tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2144tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2145 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2146 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2147 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002148 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002149 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002150 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2151 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2152
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002153tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002154 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002155 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2156 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2157 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2158 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2159
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002160tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002161 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002162 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002163 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2164 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2165 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2166
2167tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2168 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2169 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2170 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2171 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2172 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2173 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2174 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2175 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2176 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002177
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002178tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2179tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2180 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2181 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2182 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002183 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002184 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002185 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2186 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2187 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2188 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2189 notifying haproxy again.
2190
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002191tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002192 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2193 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2194 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002195 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002196 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002197 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002198 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2199 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2200 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002201 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2202 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002203
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002204tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002205 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002206 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2207 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2208 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2209 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2210 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2211
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002212tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2213 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2214 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2215 performances. This is disabled by default.
2216
2217 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2218 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2219
2220 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2221
2222 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2223
2224 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2225
2226 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2227 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2228 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2229
2230 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2231 converted.
2232
2233 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2234 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2235 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2236 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2237 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2238 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2239 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002240 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2241 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002242
2243 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2244
2245 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2246 only need this line:
2247
2248 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2249
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002250tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2251 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002252 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002253 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2254 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2255 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2256 being used for too long.
2257
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002258tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2259 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2260 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2261 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2262 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2263 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2264 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2265 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2266 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2267 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2268 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002269 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002270 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002271
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002272tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2273 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2274 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2275 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2276 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002277 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002278 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2279 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002280 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2281 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002282
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002283tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2284 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2285 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2286 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2287 1000 entries.
2288
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002289tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2290 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2291 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2292 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2293
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002294tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002295tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002296tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2297tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2298tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002299 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2300 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2301 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2302 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2303 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2304 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2305 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2306 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002307
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002308 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2309 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2310 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2311 all available space is consumed.
2312 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2313 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2314 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002315
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002316tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2317 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002318 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002319 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002320 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002321 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2322
2323tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2324 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2325 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002326 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2327 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023293.3. Debugging
2330--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002331
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002332quiet
2333 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2334 line argument "-q".
2335
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002336zero-warning
2337 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2338 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2339 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2340 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2341 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2342 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2343
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023453.4. Userlists
2346--------------
2347It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2348http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2349it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2350
2351userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002352 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002353 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2354
2355group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002356 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002357 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2358 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2359
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002360user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2361 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002362 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2363 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002364 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2365 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2366 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2367 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002368
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002369 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2370 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2371 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2372 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2373 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2374 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2375 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2376 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2377 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002378
2379 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002380 userlist L1
2381 group G1 users tiger,scott
2382 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002383
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002384 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2385 user scott insecure-password elgato
2386 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002387
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002388 userlist L2
2389 group G1
2390 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002391
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002392 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2393 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2394 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002395
2396 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002397
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002398
23993.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002400----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002401It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2402several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2403instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2404values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2405automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2406In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2407using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2408tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2409reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2410Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2411that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2412each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002413
2414peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002415 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002416 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2417
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002418bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2419 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2420 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2421
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002422disabled
2423 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2424 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2425 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2426
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002427default-bind [param*]
2428 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2429
2430default-server [param*]
2431 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2432
2433 Arguments:
2434 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2435 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2436 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2437 details.
2438
2439
2440 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2441
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002442enable
2443 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2444
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002445log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2446 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2447 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2448 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2449 more details.
2450
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002451peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002452 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2453 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002454 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2455 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2456 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2457 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2458 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002459
2460 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2461 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2462
2463 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002464 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2465 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2466 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002467
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002468 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2469 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002470
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002471 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2472 "server" keyword explanation below).
2473
2474server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002475 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002476 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2477 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2478 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2479 of this "peers" section).
2480 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2481
2482
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002483 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002484 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002485 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002486 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2487 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2488 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002489
2490 backend mybackend
2491 mode tcp
2492 balance roundrobin
2493 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2494 stick on src
2495
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002496 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2497 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002498
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002499 Example:
2500 peers mypeers
2501 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2502 default-server ssl verify none
2503 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2504 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002505
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002506
2507table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2508 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2509
2510 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2511 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002512 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002513 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2514 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2515 "stick-table" keyword).
2516
2517 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2518 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2519 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2520 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2521 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2522 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2523 of the stick-table name as follows:
2524
2525 peers mypeers
2526 peer A ...
2527 peer B ...
2528 table t1 ...
2529
2530 frontend fe1
2531 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2532
2533 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2534 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2535
2536 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2537 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2538 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2539 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2540 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2541 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2542 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2543
2544 peers mypeers
2545 peer A ...
2546 peer B ...
2547 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2548
2549 backend t1
2550 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2551
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002552 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002553 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2554 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2555
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025563.6. Mailers
2557------------
2558It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2559If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2560in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2561
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002562mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002563 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2564 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2565
2566mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2567 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2568
2569 Example:
2570 mailers mymailers
2571 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2572 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2573
2574 backend mybackend
2575 mode tcp
2576 balance roundrobin
2577
2578 email-alert mailers mymailers
2579 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2580 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2581
2582 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2583 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2584
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002585timeout mail <time>
2586 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2587 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2588 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2589 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2590
2591 Example:
2592 mailers mymailers
2593 timeout mail 20s
2594 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002595
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025963.7. Programs
2597-------------
2598In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2599master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2600managed the same way as the workers.
2601
2602During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2603sequence as a worker:
2604
2605 - the master is re-executed
2606 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2607 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2608 instance of the program
2609
2610During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2611
2612program <name>
2613 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2614 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2615 the management guide).
2616
2617command <command> [arguments*]
2618 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2619 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2620 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2621 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2622
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002623user <user name>
2624 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2625 See also "group".
2626
2627group <group name>
2628 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2629 See also "user".
2630
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002631option start-on-reload
2632no option start-on-reload
2633 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2634 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2635 program section.
2636
2637
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026383.8. HTTP-errors
2639----------------
2640
2641It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2642imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2643several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2644
2645http-errors <name>
2646 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2647 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2648
2649errorfile <code> <file>
2650 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2651
2652 Arguments :
2653 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002654 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2655 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002656
2657 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2658 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2659 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2660 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2661 before any chroot is performed.
2662
2663 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2664
2665 Example:
2666 http-errors website-1
2667 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2668 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2669 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2670
2671 http-errors website-2
2672 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2673 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2674 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2675
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026763.9. Rings
2677----------
2678
2679It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2680servers or traces.
2681
2682ring <ringname>
2683 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2684
2685description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002686 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002687 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2688
2689format <format>
2690 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2691
2692 Arguments:
2693 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2694 one of the following :
2695
2696 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2697 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2698 designed to be used with a local log server.
2699
2700 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2701 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2702 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2703 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2704 is the default.
2705
2706 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2707 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2708
2709 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2710 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2711
2712 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2713 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2714 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2715 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2716 logger consumes.
2717
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002718 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2719 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2720 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2721 with a local log server.
2722
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002723 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2724 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2725 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2726 used with a local log server.
2727
2728maxlen <length>
2729 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2730 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2731 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2732
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002733server <name> <address> [param*]
2734 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2735 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2736 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2737 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2738 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2739 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2740 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2741 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2742 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002743 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2744 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002745
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002746size <size>
2747 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2748 set to BUFSIZE.
2749
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002750timeout connect <timeout>
2751 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2752
2753 Arguments :
2754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2756 as explained at the top of this document.
2757
2758timeout server <timeout>
2759 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2760
2761 Arguments :
2762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2764 as explained at the top of this document.
2765
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002766 Example:
2767 global
2768 log ring@myring local7
2769
2770 ring myring
2771 description "My local buffer"
2772 format rfc3164
2773 maxlen 1200
2774 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002775 timeout connect 5s
2776 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002777 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002778
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027793.10. Log forwarding
2780-------------------
2781
2782It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2783haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2784
2785log-forward <name>
2786 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2787
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002788backlog <conns>
2789 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2790 on connections accept.
2791
2792bind <addr> [param*]
2793 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02002794 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
2795 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
2796 syslog protocol over TCP.
2797 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002798 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
2799
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002800dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002801 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
2802 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
2803 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
2804 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002805 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002806
2807log global
2808log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2809 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2810 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2811 documentation.
2812 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2813 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2814 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2815 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2816 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2817
2818 Example:
2819 global
2820 log stderr format iso local7
2821
2822 ring myring
2823 description "My local buffer"
2824 format rfc5424
2825 maxlen 1200
2826 size 32764
2827 timeout connect 5s
2828 timeout server 10s
2829 # syslog tcp server
2830 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2831
2832 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002833 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
2834 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002835 # all messages on stderr
2836 log global
2837 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2838 log ring@myring local0
2839 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2840 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2841 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2842 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2843 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002844
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002845maxconn <conns>
2846 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
2847 10 is the default.
2848
2849timeout client <timeout>
2850 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028524. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002854
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002855Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002856 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002857 - frontend <name>
2858 - backend <name>
2859 - listen <name>
2860
2861A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2862its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2863section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002865
2866A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2867connections.
2868
2869A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2870to forward incoming connections.
2871
2872A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2873parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2876'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2877case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2878
2879Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2880logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2881proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2882However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2883name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2884
2885Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2886and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002887bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2889modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2890arbitrary criteria.
2891
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002892In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2893a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002894the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002895
2896 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2897 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2898 between responses and new requests.
2899
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002900 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2901 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2902 client-facing connection remains open.
2903
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002904 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2905 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002906
2907The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2908frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2909following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002910weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002911
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002912 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002913
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002914 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2915 ----+-----+-----+----
2916 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2917 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002918 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2919 ----+-----+-----+----
2920 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029244.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2925--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002927The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2928limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2929they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2930limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002931marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002932option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002933and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2934with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2935specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002937
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002938 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2939------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2940acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941backlog X X X -
2942balance X - X X
2943bind - X X -
2944bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002945capture cookie - X X -
2946capture request header - X X -
2947capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002948clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2949clitcpka-idle X X X -
2950clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002951compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002952cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002953declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002954default-server X - X X
2955default_backend X X X -
2956description - X X X
2957disabled X X X X
2958dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002959email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002960email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002961email-alert mailers X X X X
2962email-alert myhostname X X X X
2963email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002964enabled X X X X
2965errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002966errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002967errorloc X X X X
2968errorloc302 X X X X
2969-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2970errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002971force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002972filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002973fullconn X - X X
2974grace X X X X
2975hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002976http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002977http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002978http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002979http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002980http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002981http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002982http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002983http-check set-var X - X X
2984http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002985http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002986http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002987http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002988http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002989http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002990id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002991ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002992load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002993log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002994log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002995log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002996log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002997max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002998maxconn X X X -
2999mode X X X X
3000monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003001monitor-uri X X X -
3002option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3003option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3004option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3005option allbackups (*) X - X X
3006option checkcache (*) X - X X
3007option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3008option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003009option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003010option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3011option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003012-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3013option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003014option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3015option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003016option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003017option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003018option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003019option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003020option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003021option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3022option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3023option httpchk X - X X
3024option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003025option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003026option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003027option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003028option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003029option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003030option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3031option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3032option logasap (*) X X X -
3033option mysql-check X - X X
3034option nolinger (*) X X X X
3035option originalto X X X X
3036option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003037option pgsql-check X - X X
3038option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003039option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003040option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003041option smtpchk X - X X
3042option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3043option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3044option splice-request (*) X X X X
3045option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003046option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003047option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3048option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3049-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003050option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003051option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3052option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3053option tcpka X X X X
3054option tcplog X X X X
3055option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003056external-check command X - X X
3057external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003058persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3059rate-limit sessions X X X -
3060redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003061-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003062retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003063retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003064server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003065server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003066server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003067source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003068srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3069srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3070srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003071stats admin - X X X
3072stats auth X X X X
3073stats enable X X X X
3074stats hide-version X X X X
3075stats http-request - X X X
3076stats realm X X X X
3077stats refresh X X X X
3078stats scope X X X X
3079stats show-desc X X X X
3080stats show-legends X X X X
3081stats show-node X X X X
3082stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003083-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3084stick match - - X X
3085stick on - - X X
3086stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003087stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003088stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003089tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003090tcp-check connect X - X X
3091tcp-check expect X - X X
3092tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003093tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003094tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003095tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003096tcp-check set-var X - X X
3097tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003098tcp-request connection - X X -
3099tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003100tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003101tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003102tcp-response content - - X X
3103tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003104timeout check X - X X
3105timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003106timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003107timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003108timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3109timeout http-request X X X X
3110timeout queue X - X X
3111timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003112timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003113timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003114timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003115transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003116unique-id-format X X X -
3117unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003118use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003119use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003120use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003121------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3122 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031254.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3126---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127
3128This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3129
3130
3131acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3132 Declare or complete an access list.
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 no | yes | yes | yes
3135 Example:
3136 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3137 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3138 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003140 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141
3142
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003143backlog <conns>
3144 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 yes | yes | yes | no
3147 Arguments :
3148 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3149 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003150 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003151
3152 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3153 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3154 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3155 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3156 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3157 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3158 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3159 backlog parameter.
3160
3161 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3162 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3163 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3164
3165 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3166
3167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003169balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3172 yes | no | yes | yes
3173 Arguments :
3174 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3175 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3176 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3177 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3178
3179 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3180 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3181 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3182 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003183 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003184 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003185 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3186 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3187 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3188 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3189 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3190 it, so that you don't worry.
3191
3192 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3193 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3194 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3195 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3196 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3197 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3198 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3199 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003201 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3202 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3203 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3204 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3205 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3206 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3207 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003208 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3209 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3210 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003211
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003212 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003213 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003214 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3215 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003216 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003217 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3218 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3219 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3220 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3221 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003222 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3223 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3224 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3225 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3226 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3227 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003229 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3230 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3231 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3232 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3233 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3234 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3235 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3236 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003237 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003239 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3240 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3241 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003242
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003243 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3244 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3245 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3246 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3247 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3248 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3249 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3250 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3251 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3252 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3253 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3254 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003255
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003256 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003257 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3258 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3259 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3260 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3261 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3262 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3263 URIs start with a leading "/".
3264
3265 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3266 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3267 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3268 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3269
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003270 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3271 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3272 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3273 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003276 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3277
3278 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003279 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3280 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003281 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3282 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3283 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3284 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003285 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003286 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3287 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003288
3289 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3290 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3291 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3292 server will receive the request.
3293
3294 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3295 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3296 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3297 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3298 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003299 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3300 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3301 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003302
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003303 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3304 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3305 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3306 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3307 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003309 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003310 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3311 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3312 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3313
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003314 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3315 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3316 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3317
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003318 random
3319 random(<draws>)
3320 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003321 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3322 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3323 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3324 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003325 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3326 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3327 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3328 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3329 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3330 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3331 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3332 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3333 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3334 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3335 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3336 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3337 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3338 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3339 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3340 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3341 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3342 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3343 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3344 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003345
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003346 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003347 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003348 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3349 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3350 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3351 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3352 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3353 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003354 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003355 used instead.
3356
3357 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3358 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3359 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3360 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3361
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003362 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3363 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3364 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3365
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003366 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003369 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3370 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003371
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003372 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3373 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3374 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003375
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003376 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003377 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003378 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3379 NTLM relies on.
3380
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381 Examples :
3382 balance roundrobin
3383 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003384 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003385 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3386 balance hdr(host)
3387 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003388
3389 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3390 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003392 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003393 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3394 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3395 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003396 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003397
3398 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3399 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3400 defaults to 16 kB.
3401
3402 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3403 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3404
3405 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3406 Round Robin.
3407
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003408 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003409 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3410 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3411 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3412
3413 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3414
3415 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003416 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003417 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3418 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3419 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003421 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422
3423
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003424bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3425bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 no | yes | yes | no
3429 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003430 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3431 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3432 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3433 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003434 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003435 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3436 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3437 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3438 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3439 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3440 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003441 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003442 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3443 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003444 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003445 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3446 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003447 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003448 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3449 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003450 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003451 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3452 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3453 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3454 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3455 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3456 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3457 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003458 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3459 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3460 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003461 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3462 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3463 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3464 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003465 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3466 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3467 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003468
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003469 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3470 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003471 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3472 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3473 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003474 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3475 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3476 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3477 the range.
3478
3479 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3480 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3481 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3482 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3483 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3484 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3485 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003486 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003487 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003488
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003489 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003490 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003491 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3492 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3493 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3494 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3495 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3496 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3497
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003498 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3499 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3500 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3501 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3504 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3505 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3506 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3507 in a frontend.
3508
3509 Example :
3510 listen http_proxy
3511 bind :80,:443
3512 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003513 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003515 listen http_https_proxy
3516 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003517 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003518
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003519 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3520 bind ipv6@:80
3521 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3522 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3523
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003524 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003525 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003526
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003527 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3528 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3529 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3530 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3531 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3532
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003533 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003534 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003535
3536
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003537bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003538 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | yes | yes | yes
3541 Arguments :
3542 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3543 may be used to override a default value.
3544
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003545 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003546 option may be combined with other numbers.
3547
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003548 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003549 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3550 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3551 missing from all processes.
3552
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003553 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003554 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003555 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3556 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3557 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3558 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3559 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003560 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003561
3562 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3563 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3564 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3565 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3566 and 'even' instances.
3567
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003568 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3569 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3570 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3571 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003572
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003573 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3574 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3575
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003576 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3577 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3578 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3579
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003580 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3581 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3582
3583 Example :
3584 listen app_ip1
3585 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003586 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003587
3588 listen app_ip2
3589 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003590 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003591
3592 listen management
3593 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003594 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003595
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003596 listen management
3597 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3598 bind-process 1-4
3599
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003600 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003601
3602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003603capture cookie <name> len <length>
3604 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3606 no | yes | yes | no
3607 Arguments :
3608 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3609 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3610 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3611 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003612 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613
3614 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3615 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3616 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3617 right if it exceeds <length>.
3618
3619 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3620 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3621 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3622 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3623
3624 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3625 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3626 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3627
3628 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3629 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3630 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003631 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3632 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3633 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634
3635 Example:
3636 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3637
3638 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003639 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
3641
3642capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003643 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 no | yes | yes | no
3646 Arguments :
3647 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003648 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003649 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3650 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3651 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3652
3653 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3654 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3655 it exceeds <length>.
3656
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003657 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003658 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3659 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003660 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3661 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3662 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3663 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003664 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003665 environments to find where the request came from.
3666
3667 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3668 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3669 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3670 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003672 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3673 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3674 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3675 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3676 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003677
3678 Example:
3679 capture request header Host len 15
3680 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003681 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003683 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 about logging.
3685
3686
3687capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003688 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 no | yes | yes | no
3691 Arguments :
3692 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003693 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003694 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3695 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3696 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3697
3698 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3699 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3700 it exceeds <length>.
3701
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003702 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003703 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3704 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3705 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003706 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3707 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3708 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3709 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003710
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003711 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3712 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3713 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3714 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3715 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003716
3717 Example:
3718 capture response header Content-length len 9
3719 capture response header Location len 15
3720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003721 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003722 about logging.
3723
3724
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003725clitcpka-cnt <count>
3726 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3727 the connection on the client side.
3728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 yes | yes | yes | no
3730 Arguments :
3731 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3732
3733 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3734 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003735 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3736 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003737
3738 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3739
3740
3741clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3742 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3743 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3744 client side.
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | yes | yes | no
3747 Arguments :
3748 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3749 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3750 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3751 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3752
3753 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3754 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003755 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3756 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003757
3758 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3759
3760
3761clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3762 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | yes | yes | no
3765 Arguments :
3766 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3767 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3768 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3769 document.
3770
3771 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3772 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003773 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3774 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003775
3776 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3777
3778
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003779compression algo <algorithm> ...
3780compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003781compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003782 Enable HTTP compression.
3783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3784 yes | yes | yes | yes
3785 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003786 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3787 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3788 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3789
3790 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003791 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3792 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3793 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003794
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003795 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003796 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003797
3798 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3799 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3800 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3801 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3802 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003803 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003804
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003805 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3806 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3807 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3808 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3809 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3810 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3811 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003812 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003813
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003814 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003815 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003816 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3817 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3818 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3819 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3820 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003821
3822 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3823 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3824 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3825 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3826 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003827 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3828 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3829 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3830 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3831 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003832 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3833 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003834
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003835 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003836 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3837 "Accept-Encoding" header
3838 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003839 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003840 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3841 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3842 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3843 "multipart"
3844 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3845 header
3846 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3847 and later
3848 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3849 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003850 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003851
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003852 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003853
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003854 Examples :
3855 compression algo gzip
3856 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003858
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003859cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003860 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3861 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003862 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003863 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | no | yes | yes
3866 Arguments :
3867 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3868 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3869 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3870 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3871 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3872 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003873 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3875 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3876
3877 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3878 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3879 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3880 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3881 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3882 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003883 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3884 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003885 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003886 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3887 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888
3889 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003890 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003891
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003892 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003893 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003894 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003895 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003896 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3897 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3898 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3899 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3900 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3901 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3902 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003903
3904 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3905 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3906 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3907 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3908 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3909 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3910 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3911 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3912 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003913 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003914 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3915 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3916 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003918 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3919 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3920 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003921 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3922 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3923 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3924 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003925 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3926 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3927 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003928
3929 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3930 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3931 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3932 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3933 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3934 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3935 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3936 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3937 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3938
3939 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3940 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3941 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3942 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3943 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3944 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3945 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3946 persistence cookie in the cache.
3947 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3948
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003949 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3950 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3951 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3952 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3953 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003954 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003955 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3956 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3957 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3958 they logout.
3959
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003960 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3961 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3962 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3963 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3964
3965 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3966 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3967 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3968 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3969 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3970 this attribute.
3971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003972 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003973 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003974 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3975 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3976 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3977 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3978 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3979 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003980
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003981 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3982 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3983 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3984 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3985 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3986 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3987 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3988 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003989 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003990 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3991 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3992 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3993 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3994 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3995 the site.
3996
3997 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3998 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3999 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4000 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4001 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4002 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4003 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4004 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4005 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4006 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4007 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4008 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4009 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004010 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004011 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4012 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4013
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004014 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4015 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4016 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4017 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4018 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4019 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4020
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004021 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4022 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4023 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4024 repeated.
4025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004026 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4027 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4028 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4029 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004031 Examples :
4032 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4033 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4034 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004035 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004036
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004037 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004038
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004039
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004040declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4041 Declares a capture slot.
4042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4043 no | yes | yes | no
4044 Arguments:
4045 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4046
4047 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4048 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4049 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4050 for use in the response.
4051
4052 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004053 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004054 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4055
4056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004057default-server [param*]
4058 Change default options for a server in a backend
4059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4060 yes | no | yes | yes
4061 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004062 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4063 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4064 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4065 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004066
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004067 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004068 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4069
4070 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004071
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004072
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004073default_backend <backend>
4074 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4076 yes | yes | yes | no
4077 Arguments :
4078 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4079
4080 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4081 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4082 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4083 will catch all undetermined requests.
4084
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004085 Example :
4086
4087 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4088 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4089 default_backend dynamic
4090
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004091 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004093
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004094description <string>
4095 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 no | yes | yes | yes
4098 Arguments : string
4099
4100 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4101 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4102 it describes.
4103 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4104
4105
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004106disabled
4107 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | yes | yes | yes
4110 Arguments : none
4111
4112 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4113 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4114 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4115 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4116 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4117 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4118 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4119
4120 See also : "enabled"
4121
4122
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004123dispatch <address>:<port>
4124 Set a default server address
4125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004127 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004128
4129 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4130 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4131 during start-up.
4132
4133 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4134 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4135 possible with normal servers.
4136
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004137 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004138 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4139 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4140 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4141 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4142
4143 See also : "server"
4144
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004145
4146dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4147 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 yes | no | yes | yes
4150 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4151
4152 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004153 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004154 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4155 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004156 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004157 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004159enabled
4160 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | yes | yes | yes
4163 Arguments : none
4164
4165 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4166 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4167
4168 See also : "disabled"
4169
4170
4171errorfile <code> <file>
4172 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4174 yes | yes | yes | yes
4175 Arguments :
4176 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004177 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004178 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004179
4180 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004181 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004182 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004183 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4184 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004185
4186 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4187 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4188 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4189
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004190 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4191
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004192 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4193 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4194 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4195 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4196 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4197 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4198 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4199 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4200 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004202 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4203 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4204 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004205 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004206 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4207
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004208 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004210 Example :
4211 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004212 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004213 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4214 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004216
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004217errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4218 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4219 section.
4220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4221 yes | yes | yes | yes
4222 Arguments :
4223 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4224
4225 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004226 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004227 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004228
4229 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4230 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4231 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4232 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4233 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004234 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004235 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4236
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004237 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4238 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004239
4240 Example :
4241 errorfiles generic
4242 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4243
4244
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004245errorloc <code> <url>
4246errorloc302 <code> <url>
4247 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4249 yes | yes | yes | yes
4250 Arguments :
4251 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004252 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004253 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004254
4255 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4256 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4257 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4258 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004259 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004260
4261 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4262 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4263 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4264
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004265 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4266
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004267 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4268 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4269 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4270 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004271 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004272 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4273 request.
4274
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004275 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004276
4277
4278errorloc303 <code> <url>
4279 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4281 yes | yes | yes | yes
4282 Arguments :
4283 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004284 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004285 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004286
4287 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4288 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4289 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4290 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004291 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004292
4293 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4294 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4295 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4296
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004297 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4298
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004299 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4300 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4301 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4302 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004303 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004304
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004305 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004306
4307
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004308email-alert from <emailaddr>
4309 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004310 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004311 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4312 yes | yes | yes | yes
4313
4314 Arguments :
4315
4316 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4317
4318 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4319 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4320
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004321 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004322 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4323 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004324
4325
4326email-alert level <level>
4327 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4328 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4329 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4330 yes | yes | yes | yes
4331
4332 Arguments :
4333
4334 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4335 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4336 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4337
4338 By default level is alert
4339
4340 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4341 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4342 for the proxy.
4343
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004344 Alerts are sent when :
4345
4346 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4347 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4348 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4349 is notice or lower
4350 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4351 and a health check status update occurs
4352
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004353 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4354 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004355 section 3.6 about mailers.
4356
4357
4358email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4359 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4360 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4361 yes | yes | yes | yes
4362
4363 Arguments :
4364
4365 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4366
4367 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4368 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4369
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004370 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4371 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004372
4373
4374email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4375 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4376 mailers.
4377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4378 yes | yes | yes | yes
4379
4380 Arguments :
4381
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004382 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004383
4384 By default the systems hostname is used.
4385
4386 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4387 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4388 for the proxy.
4389
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004390 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4391 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004392
4393
4394email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004395 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004396 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4397 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4398 yes | yes | yes | yes
4399
4400 Arguments :
4401
4402 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4403
4404 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4405 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4406
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004407 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004408 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4409
4410
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004411force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4412 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004414 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004415
4416 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4417 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4418 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4419 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4420 marked down for maintenance operations.
4421
4422 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4423 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4424 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4425 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4426 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4427 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4428 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4429 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4430 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4431
4432 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4433 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4434 is used.
4435
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004436 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004437 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004438
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004439
4440filter <name> [param*]
4441 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4443 no | yes | yes | yes
4444 Arguments :
4445 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4446 referenced in section 9.
4447
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004448 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004449 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004450 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4451 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004452
4453 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4454 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4455
4456 Example:
4457 listen
4458 bind *:80
4459
4460 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4461 filter compression
4462 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4463
4464 compression algo gzip
4465 compression offload
4466
4467 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4468
4469 See also : section 9.
4470
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004471
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004472fullconn <conns>
4473 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4475 yes | no | yes | yes
4476 Arguments :
4477 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4478 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4479
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004480 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004481 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004482 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004483 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4484 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4485 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4486 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4487 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004488 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004489
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004490 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4491 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004492 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4493 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4494 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004495
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004496 Example :
4497 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4498 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4499 # connections.
4500 backend dynamic
4501 fullconn 10000
4502 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4503 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4504
4505 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4506
4507
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004508grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004509 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004511 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004512 Arguments :
4513 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4514 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4515 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4516
4517 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4518 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004519 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004520 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4521
4522 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4523 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4524 simplify it.
4525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004526
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004527hash-balance-factor <factor>
4528 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 yes | no | no | yes
4531 Arguments :
4532 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4533 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004534 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004535
4536 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4537 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4538 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4539 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4540 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4541 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4542 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4543
4544 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4545 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4546 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4547 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4548 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4549
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004550 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4551 consistent hashing mechanism.
4552
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004553 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4554
4555
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004556hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004557 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4559 yes | no | yes | yes
4560 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004561 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4562 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004563
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004564 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4565 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4566 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4567 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4568 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4569 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4570 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4571 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4572 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4573 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004574
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004575 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4576 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4577 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4578 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4579 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4580 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4581 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4582 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4583 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4584 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4585 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4586 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4587 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004588 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4589 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004590
4591 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4592
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004593 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004594 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4595 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4596 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004597 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4598 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4599 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004600
4601 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4602 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004603 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4604 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4605 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4606 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4607
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004608 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4609 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4610 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4611 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4612 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4613 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4614 parameter.
4615
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004616 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4617 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4618 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4619 used on strings.
4620
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004621 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4622
4623 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4624 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4625 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4626 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4627 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4628 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4629 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4630 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4631 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4632 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4633 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4634 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004635
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004636 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4637 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4638 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004639
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004640 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004641
4642
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004643http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4644 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4645 ones).
4646
4647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 no | yes | yes | yes
4649
4650 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4651 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4652 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4653 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4654 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4655 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4656
4657 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4658 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4659 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4660
4661 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4662 below.
4663
4664 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4665 instance.
4666
4667 Example:
4668 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4669 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4670 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4671
4672http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4673
4674 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4675 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4676 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4677 example, or to pass some internal information.
4678 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4679 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4680 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4681
4682http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4683
4684 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4685 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4686
4687http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4688
4689 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4690
4691http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4692 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4693
4694 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4695
4696 Example:
4697 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4698
4699 # applied to:
4700 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4701
4702 # outputs:
4703 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4704
4705 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4706
4707http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4708 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4709
4710 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4711
4712 Example:
4713 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4714
4715 # applied to:
4716 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4717
4718 # outputs:
4719 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4720
4721http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4722
4723 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4724 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4725 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4726
4727http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4728 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4729
4730 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4731 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4732 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4733 fallback.
4734
4735 Example:
4736 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4737 http-response set-status 431
4738 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4739 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4740
4741http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4742
4743 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4744 inline.
4745
4746 Arguments:
4747 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4748 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4749 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4750 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4751 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4752 (request and response)
4753 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4754 processing
4755 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4756 processing
4757 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4758 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4759 and '_'.
4760
4761 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4762 followed by some converters.
4763
4764 Example:
4765 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4766
4767http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4768
4769 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4770 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4771 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4772 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4773 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004774 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004775 processing.
4776
4777 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4778 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004779 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004780 rules evaluation.
4781
4782http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4783
4784 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4785 details about <var-name>.
4786
4787 Example:
4788 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4789
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004790
4791http-check comment <string>
4792 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4793 it fails.
4794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4795 yes | no | yes | yes
4796
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004797 Arguments :
4798 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4799 rule fails.
4800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004801 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4802 user-friendly error reporting.
4803
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004804 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004805 "http-check expect".
4806
4807
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004808http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4809 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004810 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004811 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | no | yes | yes
4814
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004815 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004816 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4817
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004818 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004819 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004820
4821 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4822 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4823 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4824 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4825
4826 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4827
4828 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4829
4830 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4831
4832 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4833
4834 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4835
4836 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4837 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4838 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4839 is used.
4840
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004841 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4842 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4843 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4844 haproxy -vv.
4845
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004846 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4847
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004848 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4849 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4850 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4851 different ports or with different servers.
4852
4853 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4854 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4855 the port with a "http-check connect".
4856
4857 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4858 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4859 do.
4860
4861 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4862 unset-var or comment rules.
4863
4864 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004865 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4866 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4867 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4868 option httpchk
4869
4870 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004871 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004872 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004873 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004874 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004875 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004876
4877 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4878
4879 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004880
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004882http-check disable-on-404
4883 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004885 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004886 Arguments : none
4887
4888 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4889 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4890 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4891 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4892 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4893 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4894 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4895 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004896 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4897 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4898 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4899
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004900 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004901
4902
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004903http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004904 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4905 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4906 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004907 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004909 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004910
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004911 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004912 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4913
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004914 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4915 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4916 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4917 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4918 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4919 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4920 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4921 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4922 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4923 result is always conclusive.
4924
4925 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4926 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4927 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004928 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4929 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4930 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4931 example 404 with disable-on-404
4932 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4933 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4934 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004935
4936 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4937 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004938 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4939 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4940 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4941 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4942 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4943 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004944
4945 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4946 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004947 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4948 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4949 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4950 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004951 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4952
4953 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4954 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4955 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4956 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4957
4958 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4959 informational message reported in logs if an error
4960 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4961 log-format string.
4962
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004963 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004964 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4965 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004966 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4967 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4968 details on the supported keywords.
4969
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004970 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4971 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4972 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4973 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004974
4975 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4976 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4977 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4978 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4979 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4980
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004981 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4982 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4983 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4984 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4985 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4986 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4987 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004988
4989 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004990 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004991 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4992 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4993 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4994 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4995
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004996 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4997 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004998 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4999 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5000 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5001 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5002 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5003 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5004 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5005 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005006 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5007 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5008 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5009 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5010 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5011 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5012 insensitive on the header names.
5013
5014 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5015 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5016 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5017 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5018 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5019 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005020
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005021 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005022 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005023 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5024 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5025 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5026 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5027 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005028 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005029 trace).
5030
5031 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005032 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005033 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5034 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5035 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5036 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5037 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005038 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005039
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005040 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5041 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5042 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5043 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5044 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5045 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5046
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005047 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5048 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5049 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5050 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5051 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5052 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5053 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5054 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5055
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005056 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5057 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5058 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5059 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5060 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005061
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005062 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5063 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5064
5065 Examples :
5066 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005067 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005068
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005069 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5070 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5071
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005072 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005073 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005074
5075 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005076 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005077
5078 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005079 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005080
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005081 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005082 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005083
5084
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005085http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005086 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5087 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005088 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5089 health checks.
5090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5091 yes | no | yes | yes
5092 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005093 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5094
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005095 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5096 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5097 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5098 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5099 to invent non-standard ones.
5100
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005101 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5102 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5103 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5104 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5105
5106 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5107 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5108 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5109 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005110
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005111 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005112 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005113 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005114 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5115 to add it.
5116
5117 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5118 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5119 to the log-format rules.
5120
5121 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5122 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5123 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005124
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005125 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5126 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5127 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5128 request.
5129
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005130 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5131 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5132 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005133 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5134 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5135 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5136 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005137 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005138 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005139 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5140
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005141 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5142 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005143 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5144 so, it will be ignored.
5145
5146 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5147 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5148 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5149 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5150 configured request authority.
5151
5152 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5153 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005154
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005155 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005156
5157
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005158http-check send-state
5159 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 yes | no | yes | yes
5162 Arguments : none
5163
5164 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5165 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5166 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5167 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5168 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5169
5170 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5171 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5172 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5173 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5174 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005175 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5176 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5177 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5178
5179 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5180 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5181 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5182
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005183 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5184 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5185 checked in multiple backends.
5186
5187 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5188 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5189
5190 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5191 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5192 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5193 one fails.
5194
5195 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5196 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5197 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5198
5199 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5200 server's queue.
5201
5202 Example of a header received by the application server :
5203 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5204 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5205
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005206 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5207 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005208
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005209
5210http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005211 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5213 yes | no | yes | yes
5214
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005215 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005216 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5217 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5218 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5219 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5220 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5222 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5223 and '-'.
5224
5225 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5226
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005227 Examples :
5228 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005229
5230
5231http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005232 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5234 yes | no | yes | yes
5235
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005236 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005237 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5238 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5239 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5240 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5241 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5242 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5243 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5244 and '-'.
5245
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005246 Examples :
5247 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005249
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005250http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5251 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5252 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5253 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5254 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | yes | yes | yes
5257 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005258 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005259 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005260 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5261 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005262
5263 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5264 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5265 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5266 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5267
5268 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5269 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5270 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5271 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5272
5273 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5274 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5275 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5276 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5277 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5278 chroot is performed.
5279
5280 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5281 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5282 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5283 considered.
5284
5285 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5286 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5287 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5288 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5289 considered as a raw string.
5290
5291 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5292 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5293 "content-type".
5294
5295 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5296 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5297 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5298 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5299 evaluated as a log-format string.
5300
5301 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5302 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5303 argument to "content-type".
5304
5305 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5306 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5307 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5308 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5309
5310 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5311 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5312 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5313 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5314 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5315 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5316 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5317 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5318
5319 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5320 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5321 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5322
5323 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5324 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5325
5326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005327http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005328 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5329
5330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5331 no | yes | yes | yes
5332
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005333 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5334 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5335 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5336 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5337 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005339 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5340 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005342 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005344 Example:
5345 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5346 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5347 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005349 http-request allow if nagios
5350 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5351 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5352 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005354 Example:
5355 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5356 acl add path /addacl
5357 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005359 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005361 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5362 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005364 Example:
5365 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5366 acl setmap path /setmap
5367 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005369 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005371 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5372 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005374 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5375 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005377http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005378
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005379 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5380 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5381 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5382 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5383 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5384 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5385 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5386 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005388http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005390 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5391 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5392 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5393 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5394 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5395 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5396 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5397 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005399http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005401 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5402 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005403
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005405http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005407 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5408 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5409 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5410 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5411 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005412
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005413 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5414 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5415 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5416 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5417 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5418 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5419 instead.
5420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005421 Example:
5422 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5423 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005424
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005425http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005426
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005427 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005429http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5430 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005432 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5433 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5434 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5435 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5436 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5437 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5438 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5439 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5440 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005442 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5443 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5444 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005445 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5446
5447 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5448 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5449 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5450 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005452http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005454 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5455 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5456 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5457 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5458 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5459 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005461http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005463 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005465http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005466
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005467 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5468 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5469 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5470 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5471 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5472 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005473
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005474http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5475http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5476 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5477 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5478 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005480
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005481 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5482 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5483 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005484 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005485 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5486 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5487 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005488 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005489 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005490
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005491http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5492 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5493 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5494 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5495
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005496http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5497
5498 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5499 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5500 pointed by <resolvers>.
5501 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5502 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5503 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5504 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5505 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5506 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5507 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5508 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5509 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5510 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5511 to 0.0.0.0.
5512
5513 Example:
5514 resolvers mydns
5515 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5516 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5517 timeout retry 1s
5518 hold valid 10s
5519 hold nx 3s
5520 hold other 3s
5521 hold obsolete 0s
5522 accepted_payload_size 8192
5523
5524 frontend fe
5525 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5526 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5527 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5528
5529 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5530 # which mean DNS resolution error
5531 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5532
5533 default_backend be
5534
5535 backend b_503
5536 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5537 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5538 # 503 error page to end users
5539
5540 backend be
5541 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5542 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5543 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5544 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5545 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5546
5547 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5548 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5549
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005550http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5551
5552 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5553 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5554 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5555 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005556 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5557 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005558
5559 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005561http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005563 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5564 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5565 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5566 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5567 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005569http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005571 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5572 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5573 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5574 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005576http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5577 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005578
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005579 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005580 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5581 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5582 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5583 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5584 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005585
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005586 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5587 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5588 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5589 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5590 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005591
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005592 Example:
5593 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5594
5595 # applied to:
5596 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5597
5598 # outputs:
5599 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5600
5601 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005602
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005603 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5604
5605 # applied to:
5606 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005607
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005608 # outputs:
5609 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005610
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005611http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5612 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5613
5614 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5615 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005616 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5617 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5618 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005619
5620 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5621 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5622 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5623
5624 Example:
5625 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5626 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5627
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005628 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5629 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5630 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5631 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5632
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005633http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5634 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5635
5636 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5637 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5638 query-string are replaced.
5639
5640 Example:
5641 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5642 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5643
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005644http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5645 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5646
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005647 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5648 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5649 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5650 against.
5651
5652 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5653 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5654 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005655
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005656 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5657 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5658 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5659 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5660 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5661 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5662 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5663 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5664 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005665 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5666 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005667
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005668 Example:
5669 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5670 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005671
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005672 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5673 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005675http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5676 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005677
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005678 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5679 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5680 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5681 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005682
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005683 Example:
5684 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005685
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005686 # applied to:
5687 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005688
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005689 # outputs:
5690 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005691
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005692http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5693 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5694 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005695 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005696 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5697
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005698 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005699 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5700 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005701 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005702 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005703 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005704 are followed to create the response :
5705
5706 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5707 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5708 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5709 ignored.
5710
5711 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5712 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005713 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005714 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5715 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005716
5717 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5718 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5719 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005720 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005721 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005722
5723 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5724 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5725 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005726 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005727 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5728 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005729
5730 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5731 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5732 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5733 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5734 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5735 as a raw content.
5736
5737 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5738 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5739 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5740 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5741 considered as a raw string.
5742
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005743 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005744 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5745 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5746 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5747
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005748 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5749 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005750 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005751
5752 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5753
5754 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005755 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005756 if { path /ping }
5757
5758 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5759 if { path /favicon.ico }
5760
5761 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5762 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5763 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005765http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5766http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005768 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5769 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5770 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005771
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005772http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5773 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005774
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005775 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5776 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5777 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5778 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005780http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005782 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5783 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5784 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5785 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5786 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005788 Arguments:
5789 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5790 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005792 Example:
5793 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5794 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005796 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5797 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005801 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5802 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5803 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005805 Arguments:
5806 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5807 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005809 Example:
5810 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5811 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5814 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5815 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005818
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005819 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5820 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5821 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5822 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5823 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005824
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005825 Example:
5826 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5827 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5828 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5829 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5830 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5831 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5832 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5833 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5834 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005836http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005837
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005838 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5839 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5840 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5841 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5842 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005843
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005844http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5845 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005847 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5848 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5849 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5850 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5851 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5852 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5853 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5854 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5855 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005857http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005859 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5860 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5861 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5862 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5863 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5864 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5865 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005867http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005869 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5870 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5871 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005873http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005875 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5876 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5877 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5878 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5879 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5880 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5881 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5882 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005886 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5887 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5888 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5889 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5890 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5891 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893 Example :
5894 # prepend the host name before the path
5895 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005896
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005897http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5898
5899 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5900 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5901 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005905 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5906 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5907 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5908 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5909 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005912
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005913 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5914 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5915 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5916 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5917 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5918 values have higher priority.
5919 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5920 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5921 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5922 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5923 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005927 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5928 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5929 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5930 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5931 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5932 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5933 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005935 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005936
5937 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005938 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5939 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5942 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5943 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5944 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005945 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5946 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005947
5948 Arguments :
5949 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5950 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005951
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005952 See also "option forwardfor".
5953
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005954 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5956 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5957
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005958 # After the masking this will track connections
5959 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5960 http-request track-sc0 src
5961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5963 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5964
5965http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5966
5967 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5968 expression.
5969
5970 Arguments:
5971 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5972 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005973
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005974 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005975 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5976 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5977
5978 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5979 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5980 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5981
5982http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5983
5984 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5985 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5986 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5987 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5988 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5989 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5990 information from the request.
5991
5992 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5993
5994http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5995
5996 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5997 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5998 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5999 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6000 path and the query string.
6001 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6002
6003http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6004
6005 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6006 inline.
6007
6008 Arguments:
6009 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6010 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6011 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6012 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6013 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6014 (request and response)
6015 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6016 processing
6017 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6018 processing
6019 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6020 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6021 and '_'.
6022
6023 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6024 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006025
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006026 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6030 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6033 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6034 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6035 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6036 agent name must be used.
6037
6038 Arguments:
6039 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6040
6041 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6042 configuration.
6043
6044http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6045
6046 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6047 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6048 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6049 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6050 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6051 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6052 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6053 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6054 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6055 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6056 action.
6057 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6058 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6059 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6060 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6061 you fully understand how it works.
6062
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006063http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6064
6065 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6066 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6067 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6068 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6069 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006070 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006071 processing.
6072
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006073 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006074 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6075 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6076 rules evaluation.
6077
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006078http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6079http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6080 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6081 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6082 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6083 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084
6085 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6086 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6087 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006088 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6089 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6090 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6091 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6092 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6093 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6094 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6095 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6096 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6097 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006098 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006099 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6100 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6101 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6102 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6103 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006104
6105http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6106http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6107http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6108
6109 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6110 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6111 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6112 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006113 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6115 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6116 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6117 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6118 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6119 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6120 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6121
6122 Arguments :
6123 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6124 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6125 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6126 select which table entry to update the counters.
6127
6128 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6129 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6130 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6131 that table until the session ends.
6132
6133 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6134 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6135 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6136 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6137 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6138 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6139 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6140 useful information.
6141
6142 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6143 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6144 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6145 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6146 checks that make use of it.
6147
6148http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6149
6150 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006151
6152 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006153 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006154
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006155http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6156
6157 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6158 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6159 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6160 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6161 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6162 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6163
6164 Arguments :
6165 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6166
6167 Example:
6168 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006170http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006172 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6173 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6174 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006175
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006177http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006178 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6179
6180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 no | yes | yes | yes
6182
6183 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6184 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6185 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6186 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6187 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6188 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006190 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6191 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006193 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006195 Example:
6196 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006198 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006200 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6201 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006203 Example:
6204 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006206 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006208 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6209 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006211 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6212 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006214http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006216 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6217 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6218 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6219 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6220 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6221 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6222 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6223 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006225http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006227 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6228 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6229 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6230 example, or to pass some internal information.
6231 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6232 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6233 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006234
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006235http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006237 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6238 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006239
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006240http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006241
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006242 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006244http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006246 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6247 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6248 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6249 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6250 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6251 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6252 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006253
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006254 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6255 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6256 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6257 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6258 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006259
6260 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6261 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6262 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6263 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006265http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006266
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006267 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6268 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6269 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6270 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6271 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6272 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006274http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006275
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006276 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006277
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006278http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006280 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6281 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6282 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6283 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6284 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6285 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006286
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006287http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6288http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6289 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6290 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6291 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006293
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006294 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6295 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6296 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006297 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006298 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6299 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6300 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006301 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006302 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006303
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006304http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006305
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006306 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6307 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6308 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6309 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6310 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6311 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006313http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006315
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006316 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6317 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006318
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006319 Example:
6320 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006322 # applied to:
6323 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006325 # outputs:
6326 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006327
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006328 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006330http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6331 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006332
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006333 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006334 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006335
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006336 Example:
6337 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006338
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006339 # applied to:
6340 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006341
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006342 # outputs:
6343 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006344
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006345http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6346 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6347 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006348 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006349 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6350
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006352 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6353 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006354 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006355 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006356 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006357 are followed to create the response :
6358
6359 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6360 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6361 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6362 ignored.
6363
6364 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6365 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006366 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006367 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6368 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006369
6370 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6371 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6372 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006373 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006374 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006375
6376 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6377 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6378 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006379 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006380 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6381 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006382
6383 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6384 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6385 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6386 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6387 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6388 as a raw content.
6389
6390 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6391 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6392 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6393 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6394 considered as a raw string.
6395
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006396 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6397 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6398 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6399 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6400
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006401 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6402 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006403 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006404
6405 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6406
6407 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006408 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006409 if { status eq 404 }
6410
6411 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6412 string "This is the end !" \
6413 if { status eq 500 }
6414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006415http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6416http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006418 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6419 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6420 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006421
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006422http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006424
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006425 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6426 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6427 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6428 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006430http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006432 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6433 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6434 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6435 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6436 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006438 Arguments:
6439 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006441 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6442 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006445
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006446 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6447 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6448 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006450http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6451
6452 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6453 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6454 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6455 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6456 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6457
6458http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6459
6460 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6461 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6462 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6463 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6464 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6465 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6466 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6467 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6468 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6469
6470http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6471
6472 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6473 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6474 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6475 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6476 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6477 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6478 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6479
6480http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6481
6482 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6483 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6484 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6485 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6486 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6487 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6488 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6489 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6490
6491http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6492 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6493
6494 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6495 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6496 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6497 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006498
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006499 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006500 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6501 http-response set-status 431
6502 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6503 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006505http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006506
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006507 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6508 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6509 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6510 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6511 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6512 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6513 based on some information from the request.
6514
6515 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6516
6517http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6518
6519 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6520 inline.
6521
6522 Arguments:
6523 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6524 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6525 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6526 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6527 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6528 (request and response)
6529 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6530 processing
6531 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6532 processing
6533 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6534 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6535 and '_'.
6536
6537 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6538 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006539
6540 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006541 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006542
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006543http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006544
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006545 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6546 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6547 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6548 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6549 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6550 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6551 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6552 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6553 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6554 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6555 action.
6556 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6557 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6558 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6559 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6560 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006561
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006562http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6563
6564 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6565 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6566 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6567 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6568 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006569 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006570 processing.
6571
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006572 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006573 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006574 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006575 rules evaluation.
6576
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006577http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6578http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6579http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006580
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006581 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6582 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6583 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6584 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6585 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6586 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6587
6588http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6589
6590 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6591 about <var-name>.
6592
6593 Example:
6594 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6595
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006596
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006597http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6598 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6599
6600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6601 yes | no | yes | yes
6602
6603 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006604 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6605 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6606 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006607
6608 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6609
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006610 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6611 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6612 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6613 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6614 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6615 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6616 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6617 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6618 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6619 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006620
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006621 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6622 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6623 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6624 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6625 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6626 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6627 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006628 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6629 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6630 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6631 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6632 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6633 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006634
6635 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6636 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6637 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6638 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6639 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6640 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6641 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6642 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006643 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006644 downsides of rare connection failures.
6645
6646 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6647 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6648 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6649 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6650 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6651 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006652 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006653 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6654 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6655 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6656 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6657 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6658
6659 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006660 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6661 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6662 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006663
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006664 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6665 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6666 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006667
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006668 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6669 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006670
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006671 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006672
6673 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6674 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6675 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6676
6677 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6678
6679
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006680http-send-name-header [<header>]
6681 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6683 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006684 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006685 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6686
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006687 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6688 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6689 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6690 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6691 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6692 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6693 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6694 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6695 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6696 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6697 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6698 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6699 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6700 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6701 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6702 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006703
6704 See also : "server"
6705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006706id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006707 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 no | yes | yes | yes
6710 Arguments : none
6711
6712 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6713 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6714 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006715
6716
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006717ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6718 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006720 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006721
6722 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6723 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6724 and running).
6725
6726 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6727 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6728 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006729 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006730 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6731
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006732 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6733 "unless" condition is met.
6734
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006735 Example:
6736 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6737 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6738 ignore-persist if url_static
6739
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006740 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6741
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006742load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6743 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 yes | no | yes | yes
6746
6747 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6748 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6749 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006750 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006751 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6752 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6753 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6754 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006756 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006757 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006758 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006759
6760 Arguments:
6761 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6762 named "server-state-file".
6763
6764 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6765 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6766 name is used as a file name.
6767
6768 none don't load any stat for this backend
6769
6770 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006771 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6772 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6773 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006774 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006775 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006776
6777 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6778 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6779
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006780 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006781
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006782 global
6783 stats socket /tmp/socket
6784 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006785
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006786 defaults
6787 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006788
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006789 backend bk
6790 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6791 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006792
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006793
6794 Then one can run :
6795
6796 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6797
6798 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6799
6800 1
6801 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6802 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6803 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6804
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006805 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006806
6807 global
6808 stats socket /tmp/socket
6809 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6810
6811 defaults
6812 load-server-state-from-file local
6813
6814 backend bk
6815 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6816 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6817
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006818
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006819 Then one can run :
6820
6821 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6822
6823 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6824
6825 1
6826 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6827 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6828 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6829
6830 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6831 "show servers state"
6832
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006834log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006835log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6836 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006837no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006838 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006841
6842 Prefix :
6843 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6844 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6845 prefix does not allow arguments.
6846
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006847 Arguments :
6848 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6849 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6850 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6851 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6852 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6853 parameter.
6854
6855 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6856 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6857
6858 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6859 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6860 standard syslog port).
6861
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006862 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6863 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6864 standard syslog port).
6865
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006866 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6867 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6868 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006869 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006870
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006871 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6872 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6873 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6874 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6875 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6876 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6877 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6878 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6879 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6880 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6881 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6882 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6883 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6884 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6885 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6886 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006887 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6888 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006889
6890 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6891 and "fd@2", see above.
6892
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006893 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6894 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6895 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6896 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6897 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6898 having the logs instantly available.
6899
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006900 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6901 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006902
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006903 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6904 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6905 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6906 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6907 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6908 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6909 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6910 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6911 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6912 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006913 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006914
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006915 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6916 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6917 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6918 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6919 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6920
6921 <sample_size>
6922 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6923 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6924 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6925 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6926 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6927
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006928 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6929 one of the following :
6930
6931 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6932 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6933
6934 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6935 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6936
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006937 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6938 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6939 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6940 designed to be used with a local log server.
6941
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006942 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6943 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6944 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6945 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6946 systemd logger consumes.
6947
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006948 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6949 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6950 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6951 used with a local log server.
6952
6953 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6954 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6955 designed to be used with a local log server.
6956
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006957 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6958 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6959 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6960 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006962 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6963
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006964 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6965 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6966 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006968 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6969 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6970 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6971 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006972
6973 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6974 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6975 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006976 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6977 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6978 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6979 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6980 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006981
6982 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6983
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006984 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6985 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6986 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006987
6988 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6989 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6990 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6991 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6992
6993 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6994 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006995
6996 Example :
6997 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006998 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6999 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7000 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007001 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7002 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007003 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007004
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007005
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007006log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007007 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7009 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007010
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007011 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7012 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7013 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7014 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7015 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007016
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007017 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7018 "option httplog" directives.
7019
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007020log-format-sd <string>
7021 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7023 yes | yes | yes | no
7024
7025 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7026 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7027 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7028 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7029 which covers the log format string in depth.
7030
7031 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7032 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7033
7034 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7035 log format to "rfc5424".
7036
7037 Example :
7038 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7039
7040
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007041log-tag <string>
7042 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7044 yes | yes | yes | yes
7045
7046 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7047 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7048 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7049 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7050 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7051 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7052 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7053 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7054 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007055
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007056max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7057 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7059 yes | no | yes | yes
7060
7061 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7062 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7063 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7064 servers.
7065
7066 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7067 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7068 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7069 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7070 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007071 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007072 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7073 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7074 picking a different server.
7075
7076 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7077 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7078 even if they have to be queued.
7079
7080 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7081 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7082
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007083max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7084 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7085 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7086 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007087
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007088maxconn <conns>
7089 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7091 yes | yes | yes | no
7092 Arguments :
7093 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7094 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7095 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7096 closes.
7097
7098 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7099 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7100 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7101 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007102 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7103 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7104 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7105 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007106
7107 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7108 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7109 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7110
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007111 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7112 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007113
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007114 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7115
7116
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007117mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007118 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 yes | yes | yes | yes
7121 Arguments :
7122 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7123 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7124 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7125 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7126
7127 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7128 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7129 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7130 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7131 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007133 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7134 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7135 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007136
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007137 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007138 defaults http_instances
7139 mode http
7140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007141
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007142monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007143 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7145 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007146 Arguments :
7147 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7148 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007149 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007150 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7151 backend and its backup.
7152
7153 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7154 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7155 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7156 servers in a list of backends.
7157
7158 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7159 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7160 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7161 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7162 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7163 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7164 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007165 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7166 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007167
7168 Example:
7169 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007170 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007171 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7172 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7173 monitor-uri /site_alive
7174 monitor fail if site_dead
7175
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007176 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007177
7178
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007179monitor-uri <uri>
7180 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7182 yes | yes | yes | no
7183 Arguments :
7184 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7185 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7186
7187 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7188 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7189 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7190 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7191 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7192 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7193 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7194 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7195
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007196 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007197 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7198 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7199 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7200 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7201 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7202 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007203
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007204 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7205 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7206 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7207 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7208
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007209 Example :
7210 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7211 frontend www
7212 mode http
7213 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7214
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007215 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007216
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007217
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007218option abortonclose
7219no option abortonclose
7220 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 yes | no | yes | yes
7223 Arguments : none
7224
7225 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7226 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7227 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7228 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007229 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007230 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7231 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7232 encountered while delivering the response.
7233
7234 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7235 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7236 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7237 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7238 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7239 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007240 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007241 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007242 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007243 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7244 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7245 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7246
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007247 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7248 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007249 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7250 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7251 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7252 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7253 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7254 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007255 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007256
7257 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7258 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7259
7260 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7261
7262
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007263option accept-invalid-http-request
7264no option accept-invalid-http-request
7265 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 yes | yes | yes | no
7268 Arguments : none
7269
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007270 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007271 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007272 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007273 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7274 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7275 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7276 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7277 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007278 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7279 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7280 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7281 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007282 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007283 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007284 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7285 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7286 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007287
7288 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7289 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7290 been confirmed.
7291
7292 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7293 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007294 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7295 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007296 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7297
7298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7300
7301 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7302 stats socket.
7303
7304
7305option accept-invalid-http-response
7306no option accept-invalid-http-response
7307 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7309 yes | no | yes | yes
7310 Arguments : none
7311
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007312 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007313 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007314 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007315 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7316 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7317 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7318 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7319 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007320 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7321 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7322 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007323
7324 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7325 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7326 been confirmed.
7327
7328 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7329 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7330 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7331 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7332
7333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7335
7336 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7337 stats socket.
7338
7339
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007340option allbackups
7341no option allbackups
7342 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7344 yes | no | yes | yes
7345 Arguments : none
7346
7347 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7348 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7349 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7350 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7351 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7352 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7353 order between the backup servers anymore.
7354
7355 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7356 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7357
7358 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7359 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7360
7361
7362option checkcache
7363no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007364 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 yes | no | yes | yes
7367 Arguments : none
7368
7369 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7370 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007371 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007372 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7373 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007374 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007375
7376 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007377 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007378 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007379 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7380 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007381 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007382 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007383 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7384 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007385 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007386 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7387 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007389 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7390 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7391 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7392 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7393 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7394 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7395 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7396 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7397 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7398
7399 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007400 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7401 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7402 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7403 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007404
7405 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7406 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007407 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007408 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007409
7410 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7411 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7412
7413
7414option clitcpka
7415no option clitcpka
7416 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7418 yes | yes | yes | no
7419 Arguments : none
7420
7421 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7422 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007423 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007424 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7425
7426 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7427 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7428 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7429 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7430
7431 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7432 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7433 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7434 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7435 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7436
7437 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7438
7439 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7440 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7441 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7442
7443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7445
7446 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7447
7448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007449option contstats
7450 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7452 yes | yes | yes | no
7453 Arguments : none
7454
7455 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7456 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7457 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7458 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007459 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7460 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7461 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7462 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7463 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007464
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007465option disable-h2-upgrade
7466no option disable-h2-upgrade
7467 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7468 connection.
7469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7470 yes | yes | yes | no
7471 Arguments : none
7472
7473 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7474 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7475 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7476 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7477 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7478 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7479 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7480 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7481
7482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007484
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007485option dontlog-normal
7486no option dontlog-normal
7487 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7489 yes | yes | yes | no
7490 Arguments : none
7491
7492 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7493 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7494 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7495 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7496 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7497 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7498 logged.
7499
7500 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7501 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7502 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007504 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007505 logging.
7506
7507
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007508option dontlognull
7509no option dontlognull
7510 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7512 yes | yes | yes | no
7513 Arguments : none
7514
7515 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7516 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7517 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7518 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7519 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7520 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007521 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7522 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7523 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007524
7525 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007526 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007527 would not be logged.
7528
7529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7531
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007532 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007533 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007534
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007535
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007536option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007537 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7539 yes | yes | yes | yes
7540 Arguments :
7541 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7542 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007543 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007544 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007545
7546 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7547 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7548 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7549 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7550 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7551 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7552 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007553 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7554 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7555 possible that the client has already brought one.
7556
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007557 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007558 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007559 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007560 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007561 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007562 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007563
7564 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7565 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7566 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7567 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7568 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7569 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7570 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7571
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007572 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7573 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7574 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7575 are under the control of the end-user.
7576
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007577 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007578 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7579 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007580 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7581 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7582 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007584 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007585 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7586 frontend www
7587 mode http
7588 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7589
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007590 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7591 backend www
7592 mode http
7593 option forwardfor header X-Client
7594
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007595 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007596 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007597
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007598
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7600no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7601 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7603 yes | yes | yes | no
7604 Arguments : none
7605
7606 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7607 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7608 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7609 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7610 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7611 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7612 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7613
7614 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7615 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7616 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7617 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7618 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7619 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7620 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7621 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7622 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7623 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7624
7625 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7626
7627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7629
7630 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7631 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7632
7633
7634option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7635no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7636 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7638 yes | no | yes | yes
7639 Arguments : none
7640
7641 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7642 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7643 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7644 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7645 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7646 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7647 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7648
7649 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7650 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7651 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7652 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7653 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7654 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7655 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7656 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7657 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7658 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7659
7660 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7661
7662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7664
7665 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7666 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7667
7668
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007669option http-buffer-request
7670no option http-buffer-request
7671 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7673 yes | yes | yes | yes
7674 Arguments : none
7675
7676 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7677 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7678 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7679 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7680 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7681 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007682 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7683 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7684 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7685 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007686
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007687 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007688
7689
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007690option http-ignore-probes
7691no option http-ignore-probes
7692 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 yes | yes | yes | no
7695 Arguments : none
7696
7697 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7698 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7699 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7700 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7701 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7702 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7703 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7704 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7705 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007706 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7707 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007708 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7709
7710 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7711 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7712 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7713 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7714 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7715 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7716 are often the only way to detect them.
7717
7718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7720
7721 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7722
7723
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007724option http-keep-alive
7725no option http-keep-alive
7726 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7728 yes | yes | yes | yes
7729 Arguments : none
7730
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007731 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7732 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007733 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7734 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007735 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7736 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7737 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007738
7739 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7740 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007741 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7742 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7743 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7744 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7745 situations where this option may be useful :
7746
7747 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007748 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007749
7750 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7751 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7752
7753 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7754 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7755 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7756 request.
7757
7758 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7759 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007760 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7761 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7762 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007763
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007764 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7765 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7766 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7767 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7768 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7769 not set.
7770
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007771 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7772 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7773 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007774
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007775 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007776 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007777 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007778
7779
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007780option http-no-delay
7781no option http-no-delay
7782 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7784 yes | yes | yes | yes
7785 Arguments : none
7786
7787 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7788 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7789 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7790 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7791 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7792 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7793 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7794 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7795 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7796 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7797 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7798 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7799 affected.
7800
7801 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7802 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7803 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7804 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7805 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7806 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7807 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7808 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7809 latency environments.
7810
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007811 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7812
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007813
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007814option http-pretend-keepalive
7815no option http-pretend-keepalive
7816 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007818 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007819 Arguments : none
7820
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007821 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007822 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7823 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7824 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7825 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7826 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7827 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7828 consider the response complete.
7829
7830 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7831 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7832 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7833 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007834 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007835 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7836
7837 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7838 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7839 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7840 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7841 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7842 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7843 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7844
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007845 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7846 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7847 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7848 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7849 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7850 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007851
7852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7854
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007855 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007856 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007857
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007858
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007859option http-server-close
7860no option http-server-close
7861 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7863 yes | yes | yes | yes
7864 Arguments : none
7865
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007866 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7867 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7868 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7869 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007870 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7871 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7872 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7873 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7874 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7875 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7876 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7877 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7878 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7879 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7880 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007881
7882 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7883 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7884 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7885 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007886 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7887 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007888
7889 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7890 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007891 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7892 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7893 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007894
7895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7897
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007898 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7899 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007900
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007901option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007902no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007903 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7905 yes | yes | yes | no
7906 Arguments : none
7907
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007908 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007909 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7910 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7911 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7912 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7913 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7914 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7915
7916 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7917 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007918 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7919 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7920 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007921
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007922 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7923 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7924 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7925 front of an existing proxy.
7926
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007927 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7928
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007929 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007930
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007931option httpchk
7932option httpchk <uri>
7933option httpchk <method> <uri>
7934option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007935 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7937 yes | no | yes | yes
7938 Arguments :
7939 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7940 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7941 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7942 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7943 ones.
7944
7945 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7946 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7947 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7948
7949 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7950 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7951 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007952 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007953
7954 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7955 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7956 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7957 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7958 the lack of any response.
7959
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007960 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7961 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7962 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7963 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7964
7965 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7966 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7967 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007968
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007969 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7970 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007971 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007972 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007973 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007974
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007975 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7976 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7977 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7978 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7979
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007980 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007981 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7982 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7983 backend https_relay
7984 mode tcp
7985 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7986 http-check send hdr Host www
7987 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007988
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007989 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7990 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7991 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007992
7993
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007994option httpclose
7995no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007996 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 yes | yes | yes | yes
7999 Arguments : none
8000
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008001 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8002 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8003 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8004 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008005 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008006
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008007 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8008 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008009 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008010 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8011 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008012
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008013 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8014 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8015 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008016
8017 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8018 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008019 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8020 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8021 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008022
8023 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8024 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8025
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008026 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008027
8028
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008029option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008030 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008032 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008033 Arguments :
8034 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8035 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8036 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008037 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008038 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008039
8040 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8041 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8042 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8043 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8044 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8045 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8046 ports.
8047
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008048 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8049 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008050
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008051 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008053 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008054
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008055
8056option http_proxy
8057no option http_proxy
8058 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8060 yes | yes | yes | yes
8061 Arguments : none
8062
8063 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8064 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8065 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8066 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8067 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8068
8069 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8070 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008071 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8072 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008073
8074 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8075 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8076
8077 Example :
8078 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8079 backend direct_forward
8080 option httpclose
8081 option http_proxy
8082
8083 See also : "option httpclose"
8084
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008085
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008086option independent-streams
8087no option independent-streams
8088 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8090 yes | yes | yes | yes
8091 Arguments : none
8092
8093 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8094 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8095 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8096 receive data or not.
8097
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008098 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008099 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8100 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8101 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8102 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8103 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8104 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8105 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8106 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8107 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8108 socket buffers.
8109
8110 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8111 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8112 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8113 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8114 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8115
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008116 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008117
8118
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008119option ldap-check
8120 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8122 yes | no | yes | yes
8123 Arguments : none
8124
8125 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8126 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8127 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8128 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8129
8130 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8131 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8132
8133 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8134 configure it.
8135
8136 Example :
8137 option ldap-check
8138
8139 See also : "option httpchk"
8140
8141
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008142option external-check
8143 Use external processes for server health checks
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8145 yes | no | yes | yes
8146
8147 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8148 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8149 command".
8150
8151 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8152
8153 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8154
8155
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008156option log-health-checks
8157no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008158 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8160 yes | no | yes | yes
8161 Arguments : none
8162
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008163 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8164 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8165 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008166
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008167 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8168 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8169 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8170 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8171 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8172
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008173 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008174 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008175
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008176 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8177 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8178 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008179
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008180
8181option log-separate-errors
8182no option log-separate-errors
8183 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8185 yes | yes | yes | no
8186 Arguments : none
8187
8188 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8189 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8190 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8191 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8192 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8193 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8194 provides very important information.
8195
8196 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8197 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8198 error logs.
8199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008200 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008201 logging.
8202
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008203
8204option logasap
8205no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008206 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8208 yes | yes | yes | no
8209 Arguments : none
8210
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008211 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8212 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8213 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8214 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8215
8216 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8217 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8218 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8219 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8220 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008221 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008222 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8223 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8224 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8225 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008226 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008227
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008228 Examples :
8229 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8230 mode http
8231 option httplog
8232 option logasap
8233 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8234
8235 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8236 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8237 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8238 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008240 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008241 logging.
8242
8243
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008244option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008245 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8247 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008248 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008249 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8250 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008251 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8252 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008253
8254 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8255 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008256 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008257 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8258 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8259 in the MySQL table, like this :
8260
8261 USE mysql;
8262 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8263 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8264
8265 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008266 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008267 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8268 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8269 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8270 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8271 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8272 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8273 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8274
8275 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8276 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008277
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008278 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008279
8280 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8281 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8282 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8283 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008284 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8285 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008286
8287 See also: "option httpchk"
8288
8289
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008290option nolinger
8291no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008292 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008295 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008296
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008297 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008298 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8299 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8300 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8301 connections.
8302
8303 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8304 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008305 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8306 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8307 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8308 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8309 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8310 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8311 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8312 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8313 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8314 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8315 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8316 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8317 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008318
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008319 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8320 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8321 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8322 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8323 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008324
8325 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8326 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008327 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8328 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8329 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008330
8331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8333
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008334 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8335 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008336
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008337option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8338 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8340 yes | yes | yes | yes
8341 Arguments :
8342 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8343 matching <network>
8344 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8345 header name.
8346
8347 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8348 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8349 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8350 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8351 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8352 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8353 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8354 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8355 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8356 possible that the client has already brought one.
8357
8358 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8359 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8360 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8361 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8362 header and requires different one.
8363
8364 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8365 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8366 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8367 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8368 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8369 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8370 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8371
8372 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8373 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8374 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8375 both are defined.
8376
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008377 Examples :
8378 # Original Destination address
8379 frontend www
8380 mode http
8381 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8382
8383 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8384 backend www
8385 mode http
8386 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8387
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008388 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008389
8390
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008391option persist
8392no option persist
8393 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8394 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8395 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008396 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008397
8398 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8399 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8400 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8401 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8402 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8403 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8404 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8405 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8406 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8407 redirected to another valid server.
8408
8409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8411
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008412 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008413
8414
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008415option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8416 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8418 yes | no | yes | yes
8419 Arguments :
8420 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8421 PostgreSQL server.
8422
8423 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8424 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8425 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8426 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8427
8428 See also: "option httpchk"
8429
8430
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008431option prefer-last-server
8432no option prefer-last-server
8433 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8435 yes | no | yes | yes
8436 Arguments : none
8437
8438 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8439 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8440 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8441 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8442 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8443 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8444 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8445 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8446 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008447 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8448 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008449 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8450 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8451 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008452 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8453 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8454 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008455
8456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8458
8459 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8460
8461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008462option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008463option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008464no option redispatch
8465 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8467 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008468 Arguments :
8469 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8470 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8471 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008472 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008473 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008474 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008475 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8476 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8477 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008479
8480 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8481 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8482 be able to access the service anymore.
8483
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008484 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8485 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008486
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008487 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8488 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8489 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8490 following order:
8491
8492 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8493
8494 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8495 list, or
8496
8497 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8498
8499 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8500 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8501
8502 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8503 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8504 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8505 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8506
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008507 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008508 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8509 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8513
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008514 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008515
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008516
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008517option redis-check
8518 Use redis health checks for server testing
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8520 yes | no | yes | yes
8521 Arguments : none
8522
8523 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8524 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8525 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8526 find the "+PONG" response message.
8527
8528 Example :
8529 option redis-check
8530
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008531 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008532
8533
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008534option smtpchk
8535option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8536 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008539 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008540 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008541 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008542 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8543
8544 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8545 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8546 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8547
8548 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8549 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8550 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8551 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8552 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8553 dead server.
8554
8555 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8556 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008557 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008558 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8559
8560 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8561 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8562 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8563 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008564 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008565
8566 Example :
8567 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8568
8569 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008572option socket-stats
8573no option socket-stats
8574
8575 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8577 yes | yes | yes | no
8578
8579 Arguments : none
8580
8581
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008582option splice-auto
8583no option splice-auto
8584 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8586 yes | yes | yes | yes
8587 Arguments : none
8588
8589 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8590 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008591 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008592 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008593 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008594 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8595 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8596 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8597 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8598
8599 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8600 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8601 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8602 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8603 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8604 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8605 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8606 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8607 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8608 keyword.
8609
8610 Example :
8611 option splice-auto
8612
8613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8615
8616 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8617 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8618
8619
8620option splice-request
8621no option splice-request
8622 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8624 yes | yes | yes | yes
8625 Arguments : none
8626
8627 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008628 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008629 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8630 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8631 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8632 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8633
8634 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8635
8636 Example :
8637 option splice-request
8638
8639 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8640 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8641
8642 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8643 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8644
8645
8646option splice-response
8647no option splice-response
8648 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8650 yes | yes | yes | yes
8651 Arguments : none
8652
8653 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008654 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008655 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8656 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8657 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8658 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8659
8660 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8661
8662 Example :
8663 option splice-response
8664
8665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8667
8668 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8669 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8670
8671
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008672option spop-check
8673 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8675 no | no | no | yes
8676 Arguments : none
8677
8678 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8679 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8680 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8681 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8682
8683 Example :
8684 option spop-check
8685
8686 See also : "option httpchk"
8687
8688
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008689option srvtcpka
8690no option srvtcpka
8691 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8693 yes | no | yes | yes
8694 Arguments : none
8695
8696 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8697 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008698 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008699 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8700
8701 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8702 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8703 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8704 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8705
8706 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8707 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8708 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8709 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8710 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8711
8712 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8713
8714 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8715 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8716 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8717
8718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8720
8721 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8722
8723
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008724option ssl-hello-chk
8725 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8727 yes | no | yes | yes
8728 Arguments : none
8729
8730 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8731 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8732 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8733 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8734 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8735 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8736 hello message.
8737
8738 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8739 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8740 messages, which is appreciable.
8741
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008742 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8743 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8744 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008745
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008746 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8747
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008748
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008749option tcp-check
8750 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8752 yes | no | yes | yes
8753
8754 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8755 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8756
8757 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8758 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8759 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8760
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008761 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008762 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8763 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8764 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8765 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8766 only.
8767
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008768 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008769 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8770 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8771 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8772 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8773
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008774 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008775 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8776 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008777 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008778 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8779 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8780 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8781 the respective protocols.
8782 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008783 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008784
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008785 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008786
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008787 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8788 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8789 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8790 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008791
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008792 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8793 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8794 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008795
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008796
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008797 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008799 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008800 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008801
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008802 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008803 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008804 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008805
8806 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8807 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008808 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008809 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008810 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008811 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008812 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008813 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008814 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8815 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008816 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008817 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8818 tcp-check expect string +OK
8819
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008820 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008821 (send many headers before analyzing)
8822 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008823 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008824 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8825 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8826 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8827 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008828 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008829
8830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008831 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008832
8833
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008834option tcp-smart-accept
8835no option tcp-smart-accept
8836 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8838 yes | yes | yes | no
8839 Arguments : none
8840
8841 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8842 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8843 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8844 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8845 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8846 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8847
8848 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8849 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8850 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8851 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8852
8853 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8854 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8855 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008856 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008857
8858 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8859 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8860 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8861
8862 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8863 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8864 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8865
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008866 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8867
8868
8869option tcp-smart-connect
8870no option tcp-smart-connect
8871 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8873 yes | no | yes | yes
8874 Arguments : none
8875
8876 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8877 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8878 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8879 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8880 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8881
8882 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8883 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8884 complex.
8885
8886 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8887 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8888 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8889
8890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8892
8893 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8894
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008895
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008896option tcpka
8897 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8899 yes | yes | yes | yes
8900 Arguments : none
8901
8902 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8903 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008904 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008905 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8906
8907 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8908 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8909 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8910 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8911
8912 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8913 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8914 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8915 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8916 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8917
8918 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8919
8920 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8921 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8922 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8923 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8924 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8925 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8926 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8927 backends.
8928
8929 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8930
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008931
8932option tcplog
8933 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008935 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008936 Arguments : none
8937
8938 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8939 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8940 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8941 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8942 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8943 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8944 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8945 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8946
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008947 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008949 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008950
8951
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008952option transparent
8953no option transparent
8954 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008956 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008957 Arguments : none
8958
8959 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8960 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8961 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8962 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8963 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8964 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8965 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8966 appropriate server.
8967
8968 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8969 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8970
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008971 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008972 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008973
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008974
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008975external-check command <command>
8976 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8978 yes | no | yes | yes
8979
8980 Arguments :
8981 <command> is the external command to run
8982
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008983 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8984
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008985 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008986
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008987 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8988 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8989 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8990 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8991 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8992 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008993
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008994 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8995
8996 Environment variables :
8997 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8998 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8999
9000 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9001
9002 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9003
9004 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9005 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9006 for a UNIX socket).
9007
9008 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9009
9010 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9011
9012 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9013
9014 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9015
9016 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9017
9018 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9019 socket).
9020
9021 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9022 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9023
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009024 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9025
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009026 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9027 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9028 failed.
9029
9030 Example :
9031 external-check command /bin/true
9032
9033 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9034
9035
9036external-check path <path>
9037 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9039 yes | no | yes | yes
9040
9041 Arguments :
9042 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9043
9044 The default path is "".
9045
9046 Example :
9047 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9048
9049 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9050 "external-check command"
9051
9052
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009053persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009054persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009055 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9057 yes | no | yes | yes
9058 Arguments :
9059 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009060 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9061 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009062
9063 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9064 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009066 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9067 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9068 forwarded to this server.
9069
9070 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9071 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9072 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009073 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009074 a single "listen" section.
9075
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009076 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9077 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9078 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9079
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009080 Example :
9081 listen tse-farm
9082 bind :3389
9083 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9084 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9085 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9086 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9087 persist rdp-cookie
9088 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009089 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009090 balance rdp-cookie
9091 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9092 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9093
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009094 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9095 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009096
9097
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009098rate-limit sessions <rate>
9099 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9101 yes | yes | yes | no
9102 Arguments :
9103 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9104 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9105
9106 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9107 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9108 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9109 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9110 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9111 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9112
9113 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9114 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9115 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9116 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9117
9118 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9119 listen smtp
9120 mode tcp
9121 bind :25
9122 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009123 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009124
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009125 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9126 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9127 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009128
9129 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9130
9131
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009132redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9133redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9134redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009135 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9137 no | yes | yes | yes
9138
9139 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009140 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009141
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009142 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009143 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009144 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9145 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9146 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009147
9148 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9149 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9150 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9151 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9152 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009153 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9154 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9155 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9156 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009157
9158 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9159 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9160 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9161 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9162 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9163 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009164 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009165 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009166 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9167 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9168 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009169
9170 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009171 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9172 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9173 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009174 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009175 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9176 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9177 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9178 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009179
9180 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009181 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009182
9183 - "drop-query"
9184 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9185 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9186 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9187 with a location-type redirect.
9188
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009189 - "append-slash"
9190 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9191 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9192 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9193 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9194
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009195 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9196 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9197 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9198 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9199 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9200 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9201 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9202
9203 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9204 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9205 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9206 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9207 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9208 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9209 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009210
9211 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9212 acl clear dst_port 80
9213 acl secure dst_port 8080
9214 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009215 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009216 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009217 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9218
9219 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009220 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9221 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9222 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009223 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009224
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009225 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9226 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9227 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9228
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009229 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009230 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009231
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009232 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009233 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9234 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9235 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009237 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009238
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009239
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009240retries <value>
9241 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9243 yes | no | yes | yes
9244 Arguments :
9245 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9246 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9247 default value is 3.
9248
9249 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9250 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9251 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9252
9253 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009254 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9255 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009256
9257 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9258 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9259
9260 See also : "option redispatch"
9261
9262
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009263retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009264 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9265 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9266 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9268 yes | no | yes | yes
9269 Arguments :
9270 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9271 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9272 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9273 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9274
9275 none never retry
9276
9277 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9278 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9279
9280 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9281 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9282 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9283 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9284 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9285 processing the request.
9286
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009287 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9288 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9289 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9290 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9291 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9292 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9293 overflow attack for example).
9294
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009295 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9296 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9297 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9298 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9299 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9300 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9301 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9302 amplify denial of service attacks.
9303
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009304 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9305 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9306 considered to be safe to retry.
9307
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009308 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9309 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9310 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9311 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9312
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009313 all-retryable-errors
9314 retry request for any error that are considered
9315 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9316 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9317 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9318
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009319 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9320 not cumulative.
9321
9322 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9323 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9324 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9325 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9326
9327 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9328 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9329 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9330 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9331 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9332 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9333 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9334 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9335 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9336 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9337 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9338 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9339
9340 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9341 should not use this directive.
9342
9343 The default is "conn-failure".
9344
9345 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9346
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009347server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009348 Declare a server in a backend
9349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9350 no | no | yes | yes
9351 Arguments :
9352 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009353 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009354 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009355
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009356 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9357 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9358 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9359 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009360 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9361 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9362 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9363 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9364 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009365 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9366 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9367 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9368 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9369 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9370 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9371 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009372 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009373 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9374 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9375 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9376 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9377 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9378 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009379 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9380 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009381 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9382 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009383
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009384 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009385 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9386 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9387 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9388 adding this value to the client's port.
9389
9390 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9391 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009392 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009393
9394 Examples :
9395 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9396 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009397 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009398 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9399 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9400 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009401
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009402 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9403 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9404 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9405 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9406 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9407
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009408 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9409 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009410
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009411server-state-file-name [<file>]
9412 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9413 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9414 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9415 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9416 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9417 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9418
9419 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9420 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9421
9422 global
9423 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9424
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009425 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009426 load-server-state-from-file
9427
9428 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9429 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009430
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009431server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9432 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9433 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9435 no | no | yes | yes
9436
9437 Arguments:
9438 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9439
9440 <num | range>
9441 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9442 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9443 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9444 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9445
9446 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9447
9448 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9449
9450 <params*>
9451 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9452 keyword.
9453
9454 Examples:
9455 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9456 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9457 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9458
9459 # or
9460 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9461
9462 # would be equivalent to:
9463 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9464 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9465 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9466
9467
9468
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009469source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009470source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009471source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009472 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9474 yes | no | yes | yes
9475 Arguments :
9476 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9477 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009478
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009479 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009480 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9481 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9482 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9483 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9484 supported prefixes are :
9485 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9486 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9487 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009488 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009489 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9490 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009491
9492 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9493 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009494 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9495 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9496 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009497
9498 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9499 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9500 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9501 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9502 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9503 <addr>.
9504
9505 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9506 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9507 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9508 port.
9509
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009510 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9511 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9512 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9513 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009514 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009515 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9516 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9517 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9518 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9519 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9520 HTTP header.
9521
9522 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9523 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009524 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009525 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9526 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9527 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9528 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9529 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9530 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9531 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9532
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009533 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9534 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9535 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9536 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9537 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9538 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9539
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009540 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9541 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9542 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9543 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9544
9545 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9546 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9547 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9548 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9549 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9550 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9551
9552 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9553 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9554 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9555 there are two methods :
9556
9557 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9558 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9559 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9560 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9561 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9562 of the client ranges may be used.
9563
9564 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9565 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9566 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9567 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9568 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9569 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9570 same session.
9571
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009572 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9573 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9574 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009575 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009576
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009577 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9578
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009579 Examples :
9580 backend private
9581 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9582 source 192.168.1.200
9583
9584 backend transparent_ssl1
9585 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9586 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9587
9588 backend transparent_ssl2
9589 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9590 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9591 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9592
9593 backend transparent_ssl3
9594 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9595 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9596 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9597
9598 backend transparent_smtp
9599 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9600 # with Tproxy version 4.
9601 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9602
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009603 backend transparent_http
9604 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9605 # proxy.
9606 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009608 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009609 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9610
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009611
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009612srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9613 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9614 the connection on the server side.
9615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9616 yes | no | yes | yes
9617 Arguments :
9618 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9619
9620 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9621 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009622 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9623 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009624
9625 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9626
9627
9628srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9629 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9630 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9631 server side.
9632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9633 yes | no | yes | yes
9634 Arguments :
9635 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9636 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9637 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9638 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9639
9640 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9641 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009642 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9643 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009644
9645 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9646
9647
9648srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9649 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9651 yes | no | yes | yes
9652 Arguments :
9653 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9654 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9655 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9656 document.
9657
9658 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9659 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009660 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9661 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009662
9663 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9664
9665
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009666stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9667 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009669 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009670
9671 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9672 matched.
9673
9674 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9675 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9676
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009677 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9678 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009679 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009680
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009681 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9682 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9683 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9684 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009685
9686 Example :
9687 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9688 backend stats_localhost
9689 stats enable
9690 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9691
9692 Example :
9693 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9694 backend stats_auth
9695 stats enable
9696 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9697 stats admin if TRUE
9698
9699 Example :
9700 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9701 userlist stats-auth
9702 group admin users admin
9703 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9704 group readonly users haproxy
9705 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9706
9707 backend stats_auth
9708 stats enable
9709 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9710 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9711 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9712 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9713
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009714 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9715 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9716 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009717
9718
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009719stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9720 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009722 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009723 Arguments :
9724 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9725
9726 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9727
9728 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9729 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9730 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9731 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9732 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9733 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9734
9735 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9736 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9737 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009738 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009739
9740 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9741 report using "stats scope".
9742
9743 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9744 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9745 unobvious parameters.
9746
9747 Example :
9748 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9749 backend public_www
9750 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9751 stats enable
9752 stats hide-version
9753 stats scope .
9754 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009755 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009756 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9757 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9758
9759 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9760 backend private_monitoring
9761 stats enable
9762 stats uri /admin?stats
9763 stats refresh 5s
9764
9765 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9766
9767
9768stats enable
9769 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009771 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009772 Arguments : none
9773
9774 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9775 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9776 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9777 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9778 - stats auth : no authentication
9779 - stats scope : no restriction
9780
9781 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9782 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9783 unobvious parameters.
9784
9785 Example :
9786 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9787 backend public_www
9788 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9789 stats enable
9790 stats hide-version
9791 stats scope .
9792 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009793 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009794 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9795 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9796
9797 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9798 backend private_monitoring
9799 stats enable
9800 stats uri /admin?stats
9801 stats refresh 5s
9802
9803 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9804
9805
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009806stats hide-version
9807 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009809 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009810 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009811
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009812 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9813 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9814 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9815 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9816 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9817 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009819 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9820 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9821 unobvious parameters.
9822
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009823 Example :
9824 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9825 backend public_www
9826 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009827 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009828 stats hide-version
9829 stats scope .
9830 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009831 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009832 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9833 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009834
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009835 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9836 backend private_monitoring
9837 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009838 stats uri /admin?stats
9839 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009840
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009841 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009842
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009843
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009844stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9845 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9846 Access control for statistics
9847
9848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9849 no | no | yes | yes
9850
9851 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9852 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9853 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9854 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9855 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9856 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9857
9858 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9859 instance.
9860
9861 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9862 about ACL usage.
9863
9864
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009865stats realm <realm>
9866 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009868 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009869 Arguments :
9870 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9871 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9872 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9873
9874 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9875 using a backslash ('\').
9876
9877 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9878 only related to authentication.
9879
9880 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9881 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9882 unobvious parameters.
9883
9884 Example :
9885 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9886 backend public_www
9887 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9888 stats enable
9889 stats hide-version
9890 stats scope .
9891 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009892 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009893 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9894 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9895
9896 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9897 backend private_monitoring
9898 stats enable
9899 stats uri /admin?stats
9900 stats refresh 5s
9901
9902 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9903
9904
9905stats refresh <delay>
9906 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009908 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009909 Arguments :
9910 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9911 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9912 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9913 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9914 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9915 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9916
9917 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9918 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9919 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009920 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009921
9922 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9923 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9924 unobvious parameters.
9925
9926 Example :
9927 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9928 backend public_www
9929 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9930 stats enable
9931 stats hide-version
9932 stats scope .
9933 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009934 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009935 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9936 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9937
9938 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9939 backend private_monitoring
9940 stats enable
9941 stats uri /admin?stats
9942 stats refresh 5s
9943
9944 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9945
9946
9947stats scope { <name> | "." }
9948 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009950 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009951 Arguments :
9952 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9953 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9954 section in which the statement appears.
9955
9956 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9957 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9958 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9959 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9960 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9961 exists.
9962
9963 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9964 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9965 unobvious parameters.
9966
9967 Example :
9968 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9969 backend public_www
9970 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9971 stats enable
9972 stats hide-version
9973 stats scope .
9974 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009975 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009976 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9977 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9978
9979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9980 backend private_monitoring
9981 stats enable
9982 stats uri /admin?stats
9983 stats refresh 5s
9984
9985 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9986
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009987
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009988stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009989 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009991 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009992
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009993 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009994 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9995
9996 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9997 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9998
9999 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10000 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010001 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010002
10003 Example :
10004 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10005 backend private_monitoring
10006 stats enable
10007 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10008 stats uri /admin?stats
10009 stats refresh 5s
10010
10011 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10012 global section.
10013
10014
10015stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010016 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10018 yes | yes | yes | yes
10019 Arguments : none
10020
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010021 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010022 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10023 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10024 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10025 - IP (socket, server)
10026 - cookie (backend, server)
10027
10028 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10029 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010030 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010031
10032 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10033
10034
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010035stats show-modules
10036 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10038 yes | yes | yes | yes
10039 Arguments : none
10040
10041 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10042 values as a tooltip.
10043
10044 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10045 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10046 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10047
10048 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10049
10050
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010051stats show-node [ <name> ]
10052 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010054 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010055 Arguments:
10056 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10057 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10058
10059 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10060 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010061 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010062
10063 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10064 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10065 unobvious parameters.
10066
10067 Example:
10068 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10069 backend private_monitoring
10070 stats enable
10071 stats show-node Europe-1
10072 stats uri /admin?stats
10073 stats refresh 5s
10074
10075 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10076 section.
10077
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010078
10079stats uri <prefix>
10080 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010082 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010083 Arguments :
10084 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10085 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10086 query string.
10087
10088 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10089 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10090 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10091 possible to reach it in the application.
10092
10093 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010094 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010095 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10096 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10097 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10098 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10099
10100 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10101 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10102 an address or a port to statistics only.
10103
10104 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10105 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10106 unobvious parameters.
10107
10108 Example :
10109 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10110 backend public_www
10111 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10112 stats enable
10113 stats hide-version
10114 stats scope .
10115 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010116 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010117 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10118 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10119
10120 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10121 backend private_monitoring
10122 stats enable
10123 stats uri /admin?stats
10124 stats refresh 5s
10125
10126 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10127
10128
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010129stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10130 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010132 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010133
10134 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010135 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010136 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010137 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010138 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10139
10140 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10141 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10142 the "stick-table" statement.
10143
10144 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10145 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10146 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10147 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10148 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10149
10150 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10151 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10152 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10153 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10154 transformation rules.
10155
10156 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10157 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10158 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10159 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10160 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10161 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10162 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10163
10164 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10165 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10166 ACL based conditions.
10167
10168 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10169 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10170 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10171 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10172
10173 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10174 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10175 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10176 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10177
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010178 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10179 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010180 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010181
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010182 Example :
10183 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10184 # last 30 minutes
10185 backend pop
10186 mode tcp
10187 balance roundrobin
10188 stick store-request src
10189 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10190 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10191 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10192
10193 backend smtp
10194 mode tcp
10195 balance roundrobin
10196 stick match src table pop
10197 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10198 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10199
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010200 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010201 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010202
10203
10204stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10205 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10207 no | no | yes | yes
10208
10209 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10210 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10211 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10212 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10213
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010214 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10215 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010216 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010217
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010218 Examples :
10219 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010220 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010221
10222 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10223 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10224 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10225
10226
10227 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10228 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10229 backend http
10230 mode http
10231 balance roundrobin
10232 stick on src table https
10233 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10234 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10235 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10236
10237 backend https
10238 mode tcp
10239 balance roundrobin
10240 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10241 stick on src
10242 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10243 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10244
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010245 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010246
10247
10248stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10249 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10251 no | no | yes | yes
10252
10253 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010254 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010255 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010256 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010257 server is selected.
10258
10259 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10260 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10261 the "stick-table" statement.
10262
10263 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10264 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10265 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10266 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10267 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10268 address.
10269
10270 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10271 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10272 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10273 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10274 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10275 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10276 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10277 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10278 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10279 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10280
10281 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10282 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10283 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10284 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10285 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10286 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10287 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10288
10289 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10290 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10291 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10292 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10293
10294 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10295 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10296 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10297 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10298 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10299 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010300 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10301 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10302 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10303 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10304 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10305 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010306
10307 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10308 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10309 the request.
10310
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010311 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10312 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010313 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010314
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010315 Example :
10316 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10317 # last 30 minutes
10318 backend pop
10319 mode tcp
10320 balance roundrobin
10321 stick store-request src
10322 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10323 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10324 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10325
10326 backend smtp
10327 mode tcp
10328 balance roundrobin
10329 stick match src table pop
10330 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10331 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10332
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010333 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010334 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010335
10336
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010337stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010338 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10339 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010340 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010342 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010343
10344 Arguments :
10345 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10346 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10347 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10348 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10349
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010350 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10351 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10352 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10353 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10354
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010355 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10356 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10357 instance.
10358
10359 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10360 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10361 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10362 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10363 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10364 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010365 to 32 characters.
10366
10367 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10368 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10369 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010370 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010371 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10372 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010373
10374 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010375 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10376 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010377 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10378 increase.
10379
10380 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010381 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10382 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10383 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010384
10385 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10386 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10387 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10388 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010389 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010390 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10391 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10392 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10393 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10394 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10395 parameter (see below).
10396
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010397 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10398 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10399 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10400 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10401 soft restart.
10402
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010403 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10404 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010405
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010406 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10407 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10408 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10409 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010410 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010411 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010412 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10413 if not expiration delay is specified.
10414
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010415 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10416 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10417 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10418 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010419 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10420 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10421 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10422 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10423 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10424 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10425 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10426 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10427 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10428 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10429 types and their arguments.
10430
10431 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10432 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10433 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10434 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10435
10436 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10437 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10438 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010439 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010440
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010441 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10442 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10443 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010444 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010445 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010446 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010447
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010448 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10449 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10450 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10451 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10452
10453 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10454 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10455 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10456 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10457 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10458 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10459
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010460 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10461 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10462 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10463 they were received.
10464
10465 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10466 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10467 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10468 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10469 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10470
10471 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10472 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10473 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10474 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10475 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10476
10477 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10478 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10479 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10480
10481 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10482 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10483 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10484 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10485 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10486
10487 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10488 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10489 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10490 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10491 the client side.
10492
10493 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10494 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10495 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10496 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10497 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10498 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10499 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10500
10501 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10502 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10503 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10504 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10505 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10506 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010507 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010508
10509 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10510 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10511 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10512 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10513 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10514 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10515
10516 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010517 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010518 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10519 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10520
10521 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10522 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10523 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10524 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10525 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10526 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10527 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10528 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10529 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10530 recommended for better fairness.
10531
10532 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010533 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010534 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10535 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10536
10537 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10538 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10539 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10540 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10541 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10542 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10543 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10544 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10545 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10546 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010547
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010548 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10549 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010550 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10551 reference it.
10552
10553 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10554 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010555 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10556 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10557 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010558
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010559 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10560 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10561 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10562 something that can be ignored.
10563
10564 Example:
10565 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10566 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10567 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10568 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10569
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010570 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010571 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010572
10573
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010574stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010575 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10577 no | no | yes | yes
10578
10579 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010580 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010581 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010582 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010583 server is selected.
10584
10585 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10586 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10587 the "stick-table" statement.
10588
10589 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10590 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10591 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10592 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10593
10594 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10595 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10596 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10597 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10598 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10599 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010600 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010601 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10602 rules.
10603
10604 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10605 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10606 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10607 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10608 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10609 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10610 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10611
10612 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10613 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10614 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10615 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10616
10617 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10618 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10619 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10620 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10621 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10622 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010623 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10624 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10625 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10626 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10627 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10628 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10629 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10630 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10631 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010632
10633 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10634
10635 Example :
10636 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10637 backend https
10638 mode tcp
10639 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010640 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010641 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010642
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010643 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10644 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10645
10646 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10647 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10648 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10649
10650 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10651 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010652
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010653 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10654 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10655 # at offset 44.
10656
10657 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10658 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10659
10660 # Learn on response if server hello.
10661 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010662
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010663 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10664 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10665
10666 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10667 extraction.
10668
10669
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010670tcp-check comment <string>
10671 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10672 it fails.
10673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10674 yes | no | yes | yes
10675
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010676 Arguments :
10677 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10678 rule fails.
10679
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010680 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10681 user-friendly error reporting.
10682
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010683 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10684 "tcp-check expect".
10685
10686
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010687tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10688 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010689 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010690 Opens a new connection
10691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010692 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010693
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010694 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010695 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10696
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010697 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010698 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010699
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010700 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010701 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10702 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010703 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010704
10705 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010706
10707 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10708
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010709 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10710
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010711 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10712
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010713 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10714
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010715 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10716 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10717 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10718 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10719
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010720 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10721 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10722 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10723 haproxy -vv.
10724
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010725 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010726
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010727 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10728 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10729 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10730
10731 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10732 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10733 of the sequence.
10734
10735 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10736 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10737 do.
10738
10739 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10740 unset-var or comment rules.
10741
10742 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010743 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10744 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10745 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10746 option tcp-check
10747 tcp-check connect
10748 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10749 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10750 tcp-check send \r\n
10751 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10752 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10753 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10754 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10755 tcp-check send \r\n
10756 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10757 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10758
10759 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10760 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010761 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010762 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10763 tcp-check connect port 143
10764 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10765 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10766
10767 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10768
10769
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010770tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010771 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010772 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010773 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010774 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010775 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010776 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010777
10778 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010779 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10780
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010781 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10782 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10783 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10784 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10785 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10786 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10787 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10788 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10789 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10790 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10791
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010792 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010793 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10794 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010795 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10796 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10797 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10798
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010799 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10800 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10801 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010802 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10803 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10804 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10805 example 404 with disable-on-404
10806 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10807 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010808 By default "L7OK" is used.
10809
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010810 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10811 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010812 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10813 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10814 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10815 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10816 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10817 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010818
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010819 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010820 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010821 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10822 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10823 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10824 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010825 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10826
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010827 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10828 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10829 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10830 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10831
10832 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10833 informational message reported in logs if an error
10834 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10835 log-format string.
10836
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010837 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10838 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10839 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10840 followed by some converters.
10841
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010842 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10843 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10844 with the usual backslash ('\').
10845 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010846 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010847 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10848 used upper or lower case.
10849
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010850 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10851
10852 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10853 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10854 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10855 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10856 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10857 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10858 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10859 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10860
10861 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10862 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10863 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10864 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10865 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10866 expression.
10867
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010868 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10869 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10870 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10871 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10872 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10873 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10874
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010875 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10876 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10877 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10878 this exact hexadecimal string.
10879 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10880
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010881 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10882 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10883 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10884 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10885 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10886 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10887 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10888 size.
10889
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010890 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10891 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10892 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10893 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10894 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10895 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10896 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10897 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10898 in a binary string before matching the response's
10899 buffer.
10900
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010901 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10902 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10903 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10904 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10905 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10906 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10907 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10908 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10909 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10910 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10911 the null character.
10912
10913 Examples :
10914 # perform a POP check
10915 option tcp-check
10916 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10917
10918 # perform an IMAP check
10919 option tcp-check
10920 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10921
10922 # look for the redis master server
10923 option tcp-check
10924 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010925 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010926 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10927 tcp-check expect string role:master
10928 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10929 tcp-check expect string +OK
10930
10931
10932 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10933 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10934
10935
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010936tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10937tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10938 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10939 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010941 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010942
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010943 Arguments :
10944 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10945
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010946 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10947 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010948
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010949 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10950 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010951
10952 Examples :
10953 # look for the redis master server
10954 option tcp-check
10955 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10956 tcp-check expect string role:master
10957
10958 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10959 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10960
10961
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010962tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10963tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10964 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10965 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010967 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010968
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010969 Arguments :
10970 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010971
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010972 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10973 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010974
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010975 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10976 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10977 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010978
10979 Examples :
10980 # redis check in binary
10981 option tcp-check
10982 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10983 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10984
10985
10986 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10987 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10988
10989
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010990tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010991 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010993 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010994
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010995 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010996 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10997 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10998 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10999 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11000 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11001 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11002 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11003 and '-'.
11004
11005 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11006
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011007 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011008 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11009
11010
11011tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011012 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011014 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011015
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011016 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011017 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11018 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11019 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11020 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11021 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11022 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11023 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11024 and '-'.
11025
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011026 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011027 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11028
11029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011030tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11031 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11033 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011034 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011035 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11036 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011037
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011038 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011039
11040 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11041 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011042 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11043 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11044 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11045 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11046 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11047 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011049 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11050 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11051 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11052 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011053
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011054 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011055 - accept :
11056 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11057 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11058 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011060 - reject :
11061 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11062 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11063 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11064 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11065 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11066 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11067 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11068 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11069 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11070 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11071 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011072 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011073
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011074 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11075 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11076 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11077 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11078 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11079 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11080 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11081 hosts.
11082
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011083 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11084 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11085 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11086 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11087 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11088 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11089 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11090 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11091
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011092 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11093 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11094 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11095 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11096 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11097 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11098 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11099 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11100 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011101 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11102 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011103
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011104 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011105 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011106 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11107 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11108 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011109 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011110 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011111 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11112 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11113 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11114 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11115 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11116 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11117 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011119 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011120 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011121 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011122 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011123 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11124 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11125 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011126
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011127 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11128 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11129 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11130 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011132 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11133 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11134 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11135 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11136 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011137 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11138 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11139 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11140 layer7 information is extracted.
11141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011142 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11143 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11144 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11145 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11146 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011147
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011148 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11149 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11150 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11151 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11152
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011153 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11154 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11155 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11156 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11157
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011158 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11159 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11160 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11161 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11162 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011163
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011164 - set-src <expr> :
11165 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11166 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11167 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011168 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011170 Arguments:
11171 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11172 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011173
11174 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011175 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11176
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011177 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11178 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011179
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011180 - set-src-port <expr> :
11181 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11182 expression.
11183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011184 Arguments:
11185 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11186 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011187
11188 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011189 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11190
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011191 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11192 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11193 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011194
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011195 - set-dst <expr> :
11196 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11197 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11198 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11199 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11200 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11201
11202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11203 followed by some converters.
11204
11205 Example:
11206
11207 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11208 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11209
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011210 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11211 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11212
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011213 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11214 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11215 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11216 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11217
11218
11219 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11220 followed by some converters.
11221
11222 Example:
11223
11224 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11225
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011226 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11227 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11228 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11229
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011230 - "silent-drop" :
11231 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011232 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011233 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11234 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11235 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11236 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11237 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011238 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11239 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011240 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11241 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011242 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011243 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11244 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11245 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11246 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011248 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11249 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11250 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011252 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11253 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11254 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011256 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011257 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011258 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011259
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011260 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11261 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11262 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011264 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011265 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11266 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011267
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011268 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11269
11270 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11271
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011272 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11273
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011274 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011275
11276
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011277tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11278 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011280 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011281 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011282 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11283 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011284
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011285 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011287 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011288 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11289 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11290 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11291 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011293 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11294 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11295 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11296 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011297 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11298 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11299 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11300 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11301 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11302 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011303 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011304 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011306 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11307 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11308 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11309 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011310
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011311 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011312 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011313 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011314 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11315 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011316 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011317 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011318 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011319 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011320 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011321 - set-dst <expr>
11322 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011323 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011324 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011325 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011326 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011327 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011329 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11330 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011331 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11332 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011333
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011334 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11335 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11336 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11337 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11338 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11339 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011341 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011342 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11343 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011344
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011345 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11346 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11347 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11348 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11349 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11350 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11351
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011352 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011353 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11354 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11355 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11356 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11357 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11358 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11359 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11360 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11361 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11362 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011363
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011364 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011365 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11366 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11367 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011368
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011369 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11370 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11371
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011372 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011373 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11374 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011375
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011376 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11377 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011378 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011379 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11380 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011381 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011382 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011383 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011384 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11385 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011386 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011387 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11388 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011389
11390 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11391 followed by some converters.
11392
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011393 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11394 <var-name>.
11395
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011396 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11397 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11398 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11399 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11400 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11401
11402 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11403 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11404 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11405 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11406 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11407 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11408 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11409 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11410 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11411 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11412 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11413
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011414 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11415 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11416 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11417 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11418 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11419
11420 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11421
11422 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11423
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011424 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11425 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11426 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11427 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11428 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11429 evaluated.
11430
11431 Example:
11432 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11433
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011434 Example:
11435
11436 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011437 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011438
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011439 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011440 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11441 # and reject everything else.
11442 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11443 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011444 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011445 tcp-request content reject
11446
11447 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011448 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11449 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11450 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011451 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011452
11453 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11454 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11455 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011456 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011457 tcp-request content reject
11458
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011459 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011460 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011461 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011462 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011463 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11464 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011465
11466 Example:
11467 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11468 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011469 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011471 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011472 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011473
11474 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011475 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011476 # protecting all our sites
11477 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011478 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11479 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011480 ...
11481 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11482
11483 backend http_dynamic
11484 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011485 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011486 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011487 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011488 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011489 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011490 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011492 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011493
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011494 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11495 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011496
11497
11498tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11499 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011501 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011502 Arguments :
11503 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11504 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11505 as explained at the top of this document.
11506
11507 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11508 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11509 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11510 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11511 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11512
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011513 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11514 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11515 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11516 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11517
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011518 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11519 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011520 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011521 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011522 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11523 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11524 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11525 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011526
11527 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11528 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11529 it pass through unaffected.
11530
11531 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11532 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11533 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011534 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011535 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11536 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011537 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11538 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11539 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011540
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011541 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011542 "timeout client".
11543
11544
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011545tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11546 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11548 no | no | yes | yes
11549 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011550 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11551 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011552
11553 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11554
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011555 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011556 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11557 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011558 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11559 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011560
11561 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11562
11563 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11564 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11565 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11566 inserted.
11567
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011568 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011569 - accept :
11570 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11571 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11572 the rules evaluation.
11573
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011574 - close :
11575 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11576 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11577 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11578 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11579 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11580 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011581 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011582 protocols.
11583
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011584 - reject :
11585 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11586 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011587 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011588
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011589 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11590 Sets a variable.
11591
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011592 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11593 Unsets a variable.
11594
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011595 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11596 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11597 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11598 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11599
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011600 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11601 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11602 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11603 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11604
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011605 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11606 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11607 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11608 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11609 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011610
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011611 - "silent-drop" :
11612 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011613 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011614 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11615 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11616 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11617 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11618 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011619 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11620 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011621 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11622 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011623 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011624 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11625 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11626 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11627 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11628
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011629 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11630 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11631
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011632 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11633 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11634 for changing the default action to a reject.
11635
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011636 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11637 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11638 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11639 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011640 period.
11641
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011642 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11643 declared inline.
11644
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011645 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11646 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011647 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011648 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11649 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011650 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011651 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011652 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011653 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11654 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011655 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011656 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11657 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011658
11659 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11660 followed by some converters.
11661
11662 Example:
11663
11664 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11665
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011666 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11667 <var-name>.
11668
11669 Example:
11670
11671 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11672
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011673 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11674 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11675 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11676 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11677 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11678
11679 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11680
11681 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11682
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011683 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11684
11685 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11686
11687
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011688tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11689 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11691 no | yes | yes | no
11692 Arguments :
11693 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11694 below.
11695
11696 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11697
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011698 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011699 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11700 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11701 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11702 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11703 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11704 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11705 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011706 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011707 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11708 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11709 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11710 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11711 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11712 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11713 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11714 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11715 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11716 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11717 instead.
11718
11719 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11720 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11721 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11722 rules which may be inserted.
11723
11724 Several types of actions are supported :
11725 - accept : the request is accepted
11726 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11727 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11728 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011729 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011730 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011731 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011732 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011733 - silent-drop
11734
11735 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11736 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11737 sections for a complete description.
11738
11739 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11740 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11741 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11742
11743 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11744 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11745 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11746 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11747 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11748
11749 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11750 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11751
11752 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11753 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11754 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11755
11756 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11757 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11758 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11759
11760 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11761 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11762 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11763
11764 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11765 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11766 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11767
11768 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11769
11770 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11771
11772
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011773tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11774 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11776 no | no | yes | yes
11777 Arguments :
11778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11780 as explained at the top of this document.
11781
11782 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11783
11784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011785timeout check <timeout>
11786 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11787 established.
11788
11789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11790 yes | no | yes | yes
11791 Arguments:
11792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11794 as explained at the top of this document.
11795
11796 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11797 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011798 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011799 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011800 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11801 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11802 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011803
11804 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11805 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11806
11807 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11808 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011809 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011810
11811 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11812 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11813 forget about it.
11814
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011815 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11816 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011817
11818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011819timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011820 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11822 yes | yes | yes | no
11823 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11826 as explained at the top of this document.
11827
11828 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11829 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11830 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011831 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11832 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11833 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11834 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011835 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11836 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11837 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011838 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011839 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011840 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11841 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011842 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11843 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011844
11845 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11846 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11847 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11848 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011849 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011850 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11851
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011852 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011853
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011854 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011856
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011857timeout client-fin <timeout>
11858 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11860 yes | yes | yes | no
11861 Arguments :
11862 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11863 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11864 as explained at the top of this document.
11865
11866 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11867 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11868 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11869 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11870 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11871 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11872 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011873 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11874 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11875 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011876
11877 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11878 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11879 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11880
11881 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11882
11883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011884timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011885 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11887 yes | no | yes | yes
11888 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011889 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011890 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11891 as explained at the top of this document.
11892
11893 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011894 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011895 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011896 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011897 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11898 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011899
11900 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11901 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11902 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11903 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011904 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011905 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11906
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011907 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011908
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011909
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011910timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11911 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11913 yes | yes | yes | yes
11914 Arguments :
11915 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11917 as explained at the top of this document.
11918
11919 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11920 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11921 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11922 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11923 once the request has started to present itself.
11924
11925 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11926 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11927 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11928 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11929 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11930
11931 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11932 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11933 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11934 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11935
11936 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11937 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011938 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011939 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11940 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011941 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011942
11943 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11944 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11945 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11946 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11947
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011948 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11949 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011950 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11951
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011952 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11953
11954
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011955timeout http-request <timeout>
11956 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011958 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011959 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011960 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011961 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11962 as explained at the top of this document.
11963
11964 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11965 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11966 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11967 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11968 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11969 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11970 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011971 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11972 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11973 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11974 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011975 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011976 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11977 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011978
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011979 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11980 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11981 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11982 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11983 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011984 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011985
11986 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11987 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011988 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011989 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11990 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11991
11992 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011993 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11994 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11995 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011996
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011997 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011998 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011999
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012000
12001timeout queue <timeout>
12002 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12004 yes | no | yes | yes
12005 Arguments :
12006 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12007 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12008 as explained at the top of this document.
12009
12010 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12011 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12012 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12013 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12014 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12015
12016 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12017 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12018 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12019 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12020
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012021 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012022
12023
12024timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012025 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12027 yes | no | yes | yes
12028 Arguments :
12029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12031 as explained at the top of this document.
12032
12033 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12034 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12035 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12036 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12037 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12038 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12039 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12040
12041 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12042 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12043 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12044 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12045 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012046 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012047 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012048 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12049 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012050 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12051 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012052
12053 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12054 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12055 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12056 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012057 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012058 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12059
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012060 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012061
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012062
12063timeout server-fin <timeout>
12064 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12066 yes | no | yes | yes
12067 Arguments :
12068 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12069 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12070 as explained at the top of this document.
12071
12072 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12073 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12074 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12075 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12076 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12077 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12078 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12079 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12080 situations, it should not be needed.
12081
12082 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12083 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12084 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12085
12086 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12087
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012088
12089timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012090 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12092 yes | yes | yes | yes
12093 Arguments :
12094 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12095 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12096 as explained at the top of this document.
12097
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012098 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12099 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12100 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012101
12102 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12103 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12104 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12105 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012106 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012107
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012108 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012109
12110
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012111timeout tunnel <timeout>
12112 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12114 yes | no | yes | yes
12115 Arguments :
12116 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12117 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12118 as explained at the top of this document.
12119
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012120 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012121 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12122 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12123 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012124 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12125 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012126 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12127 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12128 specified.
12129
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012130 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12131 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12132 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12133 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12134 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12135 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12136 state.
12137
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012138 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12139 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12140 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12141 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012142 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012143
12144 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12145 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12146 forget about it.
12147
12148 Example :
12149 defaults http
12150 option http-server-close
12151 timeout connect 5s
12152 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012153 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012154 timeout server 30s
12155 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12156
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012157 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012158
12159
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012160transparent (deprecated)
12161 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012163 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012164 Arguments : none
12165
12166 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12167 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12168 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12169 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12170 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12171 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12172 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12173 appropriate server.
12174
12175 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12176
12177 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12178 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12179
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012180 See also: "option transparent"
12181
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012182unique-id-format <string>
12183 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12185 yes | yes | yes | no
12186 Arguments :
12187 <string> is a log-format string.
12188
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012189 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12190 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12191 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12192 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012193
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012194 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12195 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12196 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12197 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12198 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12199 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12200 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12201 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012202
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012203 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12204 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012205
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012206 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012207
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012208 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012209
12210 will generate:
12211
12212 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12213
12214 See also: "unique-id-header"
12215
12216unique-id-header <name>
12217 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12219 yes | yes | yes | no
12220 Arguments :
12221 <name> is the name of the header.
12222
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012223 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12224 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012225
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012226 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012227
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012228 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012229 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12230
12231 will generate:
12232
12233 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12234
12235 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012236
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012237use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012238 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12240 no | yes | yes | no
12241 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012242 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12243 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012244
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012245 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12246 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012247
12248 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12249 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12250 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012251 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012252 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012253 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12254 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012255
12256 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12257 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12258 assign the backend.
12259
12260 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12261 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12262 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12263 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12264 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12265 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12266
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012267 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012268 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012269 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12270 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12271 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12272
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012273 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12274 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12275 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12276 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12277 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12278 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12279 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12280 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12281 cannot be forced from the request.
12282
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012283 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012284 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12285 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12286
12287 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12288 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012289
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012290use-fcgi-app <name>
12291 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12293 no | no | yes | yes
12294 Arguments :
12295 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12296
12297 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012298
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012299use-server <server> if <condition>
12300use-server <server> unless <condition>
12301 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12303 no | no | yes | yes
12304 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012305 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12306 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012307
12308 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12309
12310 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12311 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12312 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12313
12314 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12315 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12316 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12317 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12318 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12319 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12320 matches will assign the server.
12321
12322 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12323 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12324 with the next rules until one matches.
12325
12326 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12327 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12328 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12329 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12330
12331 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12332 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12333 stripped.
12334
12335 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12336 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012337 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12338 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12339 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012340
12341 Example :
12342 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12343 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12344 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12345 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012346 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012347 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012348 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012349 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12350 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12351
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012352 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12353 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12354 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12355 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012356 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012357 and we fall back to load balancing.
12358
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012359 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012361
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012363--------------------------
12364
12365The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12366depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12367settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12368written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12369described in this section.
12370
12371
123725.1. Bind options
12373-----------------
12374
12375The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12376as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12377no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12378parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12379while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12380provided immediately after the setting name.
12381
12382The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12383
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012384accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12385 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12386 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12387 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12388 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12389 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12390 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12391 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12392 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12393 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012394 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12395 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12396 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012398accept-proxy
12399 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012400 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12401 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012402 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12403 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12404 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12405 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012406 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012407 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12408 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012409 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12410 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012411
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012412allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012413 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012414 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012415 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012416 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12417 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012418
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012419alpn <protocols>
12420 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12421 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12422 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012423 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012424 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012425 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12426 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12427 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12428 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12429 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12430 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12431 preference, like below :
12432
12433 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012434
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012435backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012436 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012437 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12438
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012439curves <curves>
12440 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12441 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12442 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12443 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12444 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12445 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12446
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012447ecdhe <named curve>
12448 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012449 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12450 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012451
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012452ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12454 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12455 client's certificate.
12456
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012457ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12459 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12460 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12461 error is ignored.
12462
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012463ca-sign-file <cafile>
12464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12465 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12466 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12467 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12468 'generate-certificates' for details.
12469
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012470ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12472 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12473 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12474 'generate-certificates' for details.
12475
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012476ca-verify-file <cafile>
12477 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12478 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12479 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12480 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12481 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12482
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012483ciphers <ciphers>
12484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12485 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012486 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012487 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012488 information and recommendations see e.g.
12489 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12490 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12491 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12492
12493ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12494 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12495 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12496 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12497 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012498 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12499 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012500
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012501crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12503 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12504 to verify client's certificate.
12505
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012506crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12508 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12509 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12510 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12511 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012512 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12513 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012514
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012515 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12516 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12517
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012518 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12519 are loaded.
12520
12521 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012522 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12523 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12524 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12525 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12526 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12527 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12528 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012529 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012530
12531 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12532 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12533 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12534 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012535 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12536 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012537
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012538 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012539
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012540 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012541 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012542 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12543 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012544 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12545 clients).
12546
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012547 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12548 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12549 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12550 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12551 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12552 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12553 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12554 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12555 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12556 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12557 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12558 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12559 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12560
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012561 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12562 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12563 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12564 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12565 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12566
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012567 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12568 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12569 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12570 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012571
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012572 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12573 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12574 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012575
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012576crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012578 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012579 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012580 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012581
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012582crt-list <file>
12583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012584 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12585 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012586
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012587 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12588
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012589 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12590 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12591 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12592 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12593 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012594
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012595 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12596 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12597 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12598 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12599 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12600 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12601 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12602 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012603
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012604 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12605 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12606 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012607
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012608 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12609
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012610 crt-list file example:
12611 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012612 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012613 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012614 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012615 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012616
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012617defer-accept
12618 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12619 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12620 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012621 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012622 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12623 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12624 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12625 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12626 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12627 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12628 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12629
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012630expose-fd listeners
12631 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12632 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012633 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12634 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012635 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012636
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012637force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012638 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012639 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012640 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012641 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012642
12643force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012644 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012645 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012646 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012647
12648force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012649 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012650 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012651 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012652
12653force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012654 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012655 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012656 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012657
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012658force-tlsv13
12659 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12660 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012661 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012662
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012663generate-certificates
12664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12665 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12666 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12667 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12668 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12669 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12670 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12671 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12672 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12673 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12674 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12675
12676 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12677 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012678 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012679 certificate is used many times.
12680
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012681gid <gid>
12682 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12683 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12684 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12685 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12686 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12687
12688group <group>
12689 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12690 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12691 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12692 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12693 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12694
12695id <id>
12696 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12697 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12698 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12699 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12700
12701interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012702 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12703 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12704 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12705 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12706 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12707 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012708 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12709 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12710 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12711 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12712 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12713 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012714
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012715level <level>
12716 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12717 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12718 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012719 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012720 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12721 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12722 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012723 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012724 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012725 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012726 all counters).
12727
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012728severity-output <format>
12729 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12730 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12731 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12732 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12733 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12734 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12735 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12736 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12737 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12738 rfc5424 convention.
12739
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012740maxconn <maxconn>
12741 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12742 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12743 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12744 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12745 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12746 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12747 eat all memory.
12748
12749mode <mode>
12750 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12751 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12752 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12753 UNIX sockets.
12754
12755mss <maxseg>
12756 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12757 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12758 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12759 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12760 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12761 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12762 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12763 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12764 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12765 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12766 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12767
12768name <name>
12769 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12770 page.
12771
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012772namespace <name>
12773 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12774 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12775 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12776 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12777
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012778nice <nice>
12779 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12780 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12781 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12782 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12783 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12784 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12785 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12786 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12787 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12788 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12789 one for an RDP socket.
12790
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012791no-ca-names
12792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12793 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012794 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012795
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012796no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012798 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012799 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012800 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012801 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12802 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012803
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012804no-tls-tickets
12805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12806 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12807 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012808 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12809 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012810 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12811 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12812 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012813
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012814no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012816 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012817 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012818 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012819 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12820 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012821
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012822no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012824 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012825 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012826 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012827 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12828 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012829
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012830no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012832 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012833 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012834 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012835 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12836 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012837
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012838no-tlsv13
12839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12840 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12841 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12842 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012843 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12844 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012845
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012846npn <protocols>
12847 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12848 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12849 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012850 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012851 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012852 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12853 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12854 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12855 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12856 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012857
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012858prefer-client-ciphers
12859 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12860 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12861 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012862 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12863 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12864 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012865
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012866process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012867 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012868 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012869 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012870 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12871 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12872 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12873 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012874 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012875 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12876 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12877 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12878 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12879 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012880
12881 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12882
12883 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12884 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12885 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12886 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12887 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12888 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12889 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12890 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012891
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012892proto <name>
12893 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12894 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12895 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12896 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012897 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012898 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012899 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012900 h2" on the bind line.
12901
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012902ssl
12903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012904 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012905 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12906 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012907 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12908 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012909
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012910ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12911 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012912 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12913 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12914 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012915 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12916
12917ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012918 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12919 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12920 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12921 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012922
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012923strict-sni
12924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12925 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12926 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12927 See the "crt" option for more information.
12928
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012929tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012930 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012931 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12932 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012933 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012934 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12935 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12936 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12937 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12938 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12939 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12940 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12941
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012942tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012943 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012944 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12945 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12946 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12947 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12948 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12949 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12950 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012951 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12952 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12953 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012954
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012955tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12956 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012957 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12958 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12959 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12960 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12961 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12962 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12963 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12964 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12965 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12966 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012967 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12968 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12969
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012970transparent
12971 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12972 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12973 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12974 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12975 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12976 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12977 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12978 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12979 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12980 so check for support with your vendor.
12981
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012982v4v6
12983 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12984 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12985 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12986 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012987 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012988
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012989v6only
12990 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12991 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12992 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012993 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12994 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012995
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012996uid <uid>
12997 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12998 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12999 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13000 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13001 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13002
13003user <user>
13004 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13005 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13006 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13007 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13008 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13009
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013010verify [none|optional|required]
13011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13012 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13013 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13014 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13015 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013016 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13017 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13018 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13019 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013020
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200130215.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013022------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013024The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13025which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13026arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13027settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13028after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13029Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13030address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013032 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013033 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013034
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013035Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13036keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013038The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013039
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013040addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013041 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013042 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13043 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13044 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13045 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13046 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013047
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013048agent-check
13049 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013050 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013051 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13052 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13053 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013054
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013055 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013056 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013057 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13058 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13059 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013060
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013061 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13062 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13063 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13064 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13065 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013066
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013067 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013068 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013069
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013070 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13071 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13072 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013073
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013074 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13075 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13076 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013077
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013078 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013079 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13080 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13081 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13082 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013083 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013084 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013085
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013086 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13087 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013088
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013089 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13090 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13091 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13092 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13093 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13094 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13095 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13096 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13097 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013098
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013099 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13100 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013101 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13102 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13103 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013104 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013105
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013106 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013107 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013108
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013109agent-send <string>
13110 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13111 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13112 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13113 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13114 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13115
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013116agent-inter <delay>
13117 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13118 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13119
13120 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13121 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13122 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13123 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13124 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13125 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13126 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13127 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13128 of backends use the same servers.
13129
13130 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13131
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013132agent-addr <addr>
13133 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13134
13135 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13136 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13137 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13138 hostname, it will be resolved.
13139
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013140agent-port <port>
13141 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13142
13143 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13144
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013145allow-0rtt
13146 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013147 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13148 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013149
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013150alpn <protocols>
13151 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13152 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13153 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013154 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013155 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13156 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13157 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13158 now obsolete NPN extension.
13159 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13160 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13161
13162 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013164backup
13165 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13166 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13167 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13168 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013169 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13170 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013171
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013172ca-file <cafile>
13173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13174 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13175 server's certificate.
13176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013177check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013178 This option enables health checks on a server:
13179 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13180 considered available.
13181 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13182 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13183 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13184 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13185 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13186 set.
13187 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13188 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13189 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13190 exchanges succeed.
13191
13192 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13193 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13194 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13195 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13196 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013197 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013198 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13199
13200 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13201 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13202
13203 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13204 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13205
13206 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13207 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13208 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13209 available.
13210
13211 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13212 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13213 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13214
13215 Example:
13216 # simple tcp check
13217 backend foo
13218 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13219 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13220 backend foo
13221 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13222 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13223 backend foo
13224 option tcp-check
13225 tcp-check connect
13226 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013227
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013228check-send-proxy
13229 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13230 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13231 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13232 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13233 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13234 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13235 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13236
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013237check-alpn <protocols>
13238 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13239 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13240 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13241
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013242check-proto <name>
13243 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13244 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13245 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13246 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013247 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013248 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13249 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13250
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013251check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013252 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013253 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13254 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013255
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013256check-ssl
13257 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13258 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13259 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13260 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013261 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013262 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13263 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013264 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013265 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13266 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013267
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013268check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013269 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013270 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13271 for normal traffic.
13272
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013273ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13275 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13276 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013277 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13278 information and recommendations see e.g.
13279 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13280 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13281 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013282
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013283ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13285 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13286 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13287 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013288 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13289 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13290 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013292cookie <value>
13293 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13294 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13295 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13296 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13297 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13298 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13299 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13300
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013301crl-file <crlfile>
13302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13303 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13304 to verify server's certificate.
13305
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013306crt <cert>
13307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13308 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13309 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13310 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13311 certificate request.
13312
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013313disabled
13314 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13315 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13316 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13317 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13318 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013319 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013320
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013321enabled
13322 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13323 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13324 default value.
13325 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13326 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013328error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013329 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13330 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13331 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013333 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013335fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013336 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13337 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13338 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13339
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013340force-sslv3
13341 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13342 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013343 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013344 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013345
13346force-tlsv10
13347 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013348 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013349 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013350
13351force-tlsv11
13352 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013353 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013354 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013355
13356force-tlsv12
13357 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013358 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013359 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013360
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013361force-tlsv13
13362 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13363 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013364 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013366id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013367 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13368 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13369 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013370
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013371init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13372 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13373 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013374 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013375 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13376 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13377 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13378 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13379 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13380 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13381 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13382 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13383 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013384 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013385 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13386 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13387 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13388 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13389 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13390 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013391 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013392
13393 Example:
13394 defaults
13395 # never fail on address resolution
13396 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013398inter <delay>
13399fastinter <delay>
13400downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013401 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13402 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13403 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13404 between checks depending on the server state :
13405
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013406 Server state | Interval used
13407 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13408 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13409 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13410 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13411 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13412 or yet unchecked. |
13413 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13414 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13415 | "inter" otherwise.
13416 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013418 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13419 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13420 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13421 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013422 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13423 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13424 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13425 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13426 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013427
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013428log-proto <logproto>
13429 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13430 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13431 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13432 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013434maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013435 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13436 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013437 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13438 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013439 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13440 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13441 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13442 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13443
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013444 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13445 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13446 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13447 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13448 than 50 concurrent requests.
13449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013450maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013451 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13452 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13453 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13454 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013455 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13456 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13457 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13458 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13459 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13460 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13461 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013462
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013463max-reuse <count>
13464 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13465 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13466 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13467 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13468 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13469 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13470 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13471 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013473minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013474 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13475 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13476 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13477 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13478 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13479 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013480 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013481 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013482
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013483namespace <name>
13484 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13485 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13486 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13487 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13488
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013489no-agent-check
13490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13492 default value.
13493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13494 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13495
13496no-backup
13497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13499 default value.
13500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13501 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13502
13503no-check
13504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13506 default value.
13507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13508 "default-server" "check" setting.
13509
13510no-check-ssl
13511 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13512 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13513 default value.
13514 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13515 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13516
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013517no-send-proxy
13518 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13519 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13520 default value.
13521 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13522 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13523
13524no-send-proxy-v2
13525 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13526 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13527 default value.
13528 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13529 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13530
13531no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13532 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13533 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13534 default value.
13535 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13536 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13537
13538no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13539 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13540 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13541 default value.
13542 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13543 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13544
13545no-ssl
13546 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13547 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13548 default value.
13549 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13550 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13551
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013552no-ssl-reuse
13553 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13554 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13555 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13556 and for paranoid users.
13557
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013558no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013559 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13560 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013561 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013562
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013563 Supported in default-server: No
13564
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013565no-tls-tickets
13566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13567 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13568 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013569 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13570 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013571 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13572 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13573 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013574 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013575
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013576no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013577 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013578 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13579 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013580 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13581 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013582 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013583
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013584 Supported in default-server: No
13585
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013586no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013587 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013588 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13589 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013590 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13591 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013592 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013593
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013594 Supported in default-server: No
13595
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013596no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013597 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013598 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13599 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013600 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13601 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013602 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013603
13604 Supported in default-server: No
13605
13606no-tlsv13
13607 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13608 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13609 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13610 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13611 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013612 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013613
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013614 Supported in default-server: No
13615
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013616no-verifyhost
13617 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13618 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13619 default value.
13620 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13621 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013622
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013623no-tfo
13624 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13625 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13626 default value.
13627 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13628 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13629
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013630non-stick
13631 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13632 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13633 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13634
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013635npn <protocols>
13636 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13637 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13638 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013639 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013640 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13641 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13642 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013644observe <mode>
13645 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13646 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13647 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13648 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13649 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13650 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013651 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013652
13653 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013655on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013656 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13657 Currently, four modes are available:
13658 - fastinter: force fastinter
13659 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13660 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13661 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13662 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13663
13664 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13665
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013666on-marked-down <action>
13667 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13668 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013669 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13670 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13671 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13672 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13673 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13674 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13675 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13676 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013677
13678 Actions are disabled by default
13679
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013680on-marked-up <action>
13681 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13682 Currently one action is available:
13683 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13684 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13685 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13686 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013687 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13688 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013689 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13690 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13691
13692 Actions are disabled by default
13693
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013694pool-low-conn <max>
13695 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13696 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13697 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13698 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13699 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13700 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13701 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13702 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13703 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13704 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13705 applying to "http-reuse".
13706
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013707pool-max-conn <max>
13708 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13709 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13710 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13711 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13712 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13713 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13714
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013715pool-purge-delay <delay>
13716 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013717 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013718 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013720port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013721 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13722 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13723 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13724 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13725 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13726 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13727
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013728proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013729 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13730 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13731 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13732 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013733 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013734 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013736redir <prefix>
13737 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13738 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13739 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13740 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13741 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13742 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13743 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13744 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013745 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013747 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13748 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13749 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13750 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13751
13752 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013754rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013755 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13756 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13757 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13758
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013759resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13760 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13761 server.
13762
13763 Available options:
13764
13765 * allow-dup-ip
13766 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13767 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13768 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13769 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13770 For such case, simply enable this option.
13771 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13772
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013773 * ignore-weight
13774 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13775 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13776 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13777
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013778 * prevent-dup-ip
13779 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13780 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13781 same fqdn.
13782 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13783
13784 Example:
13785 backend b_myapp
13786 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13787 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13788 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13789
13790 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13791 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13792 it
13793 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13794 different address
13795
13796 Default value: not set
13797
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013798resolve-prefer <family>
13799 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13800 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13801 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13802 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13803
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013804 Default value: ipv6
13805
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013806 Example:
13807
13808 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013809
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013810resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013811 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013812 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013813 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013814 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13815 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013816 configured network, another address is selected.
13817
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013818 Example:
13819
13820 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013821
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013822resolvers <id>
13823 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13824 hostname.
13825
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013826 Example:
13827
13828 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013829
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013830 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013831
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013832send-proxy
13833 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13834 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13835 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13836 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013837 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13838 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13839 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13840 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13841 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13842 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13843 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13844 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13845 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13846 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013847 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13848 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013849
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013850send-proxy-v2
13851 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13852 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13853 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13854 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013855 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13856 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13857 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13858 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013859
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013860proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013861 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13862 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13863
13864 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13865 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13866 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13867 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13868 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13869 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13870 connection is supported).
13871 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13872 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13873 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13874 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13875 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13876 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13877 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013878
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013879send-proxy-v2-ssl
13880 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13881 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13882 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13883 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13884 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13885 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13886 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013887 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13888 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013889
13890send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13891 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13892 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13893 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13894 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13895 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13896 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13897 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13898 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013899 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13900 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013902slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013903 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13904 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13905 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13906 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13907 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13908 parameters :
13909
13910 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13911 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13912
13913 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13914 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13915 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13916 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13917
13918 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13919 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13920 seen as failed.
13921
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013922sni <expression>
13923 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13924 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13925 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13926 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013927 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13928 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013929 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013930 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13931 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013932
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013933source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013934source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013935source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013936 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13937 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13938 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13939 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13940
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013941 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13942 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13943 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13944 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13945 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13946 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13947 server.
13948
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013949 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13950 specifying the source address without port(s).
13951
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013952ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013953 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13954 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13955 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13956 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13957 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13958 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013959 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13960 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013961
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013962ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13963 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13964 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13965 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13966
13967ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13968 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13969 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13970 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13971
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013972ssl-reuse
13973 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13974 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13975 default value.
13976 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13977 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13978
13979stick
13980 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13981 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13982 default value.
13983 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13984 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013985
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013986socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013987 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013988 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13989 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13990
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013991tcp-ut <delay>
13992 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13993 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13994 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013995 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013996 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13997 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13998 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13999 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14000 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14001 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14002 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14003 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14004 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14005
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014006tfo
14007 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14008 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14009 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14010 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14011 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014012 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014014track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014015 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14016 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14017 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14018 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014019 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14020
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014021tls-tickets
14022 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14023 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14024 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014025 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14026 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14027 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014028 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014029 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014030
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014031verify [none|required]
14032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014033 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014034 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14035 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014036 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014037 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14038 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14039 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14040 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14041 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14042 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14043 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14044 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014045
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014046verifyhost <hostname>
14047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014048 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14049 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14050 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14051 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14052 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14053 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14054 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14055 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014057weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014058 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14059 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14060 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014061 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14062 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14063 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14064 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14065 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14066 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014067
14068
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140695.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14070-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014071
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014072HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14073using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14074configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014075This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14076can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14077workload.
14078This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14079resolution at run time.
14080Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14081carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14082
14083
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140845.3.1. Global overview
14085----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014086
14087As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14088different steps of the process life:
14089
14090 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14091 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14092 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14093
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014094 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14095 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014096
14097A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14098 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14099 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14100 resolution to know this new IP.
14101
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014102When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014103HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014104SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14105from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14106will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14107will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014108
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014109A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014110 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014111 first valid response.
14112
14113 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14114 servers return an error.
14115
14116
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141175.3.2. The resolvers section
14118----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014119
14120This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014121HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14122contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014123
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014124When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14125uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14126is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14127answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14128
14129When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014130used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014131
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014132 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14133 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14134 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014135
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014136 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14137 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014138
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014139 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14140 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14141 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014142
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014143For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14144following scenarios are possible:
14145
14146 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14147 ignored
14148
14149 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14150 applied
14151
14152 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14153 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14154
14155 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14156 retries the query with a new type
14157
14158 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14159 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014160
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014161As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14162a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014163<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014164
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014165
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014166resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014167 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014168
14169A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14170
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014171accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014172 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014173 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014174 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14175 by RFC 6891)
14176
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014177 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14178
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014179nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14180 DNS server description:
14181 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14182 <ip> : IP address of the server
14183 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14184
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014185parse-resolv-conf
14186 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14187 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14188 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14189
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014190hold <status> <period>
14191 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14192 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014193 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014194 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014195 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14196 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14197 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14198
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014199 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014200
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014201resolve_retries <nb>
14202 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14203 giving up.
14204 Default value: 3
14205
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014206 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14207 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14208 type.
14209
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014210timeout <event> <time>
14211 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14212 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14213 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014214 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14215 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014216 Default value: 1s
14217 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014218 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014219 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014220 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14221 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14222
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014223 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014224
14225 resolvers mydns
14226 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14227 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014228 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014229 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014230 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014231 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014232 hold other 30s
14233 hold refused 30s
14234 hold nx 30s
14235 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014236 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014237 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014238
14239
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142406. Cache
14241---------
14242
14243HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14244(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14245RAM.
14246
14247The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14248this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14249
14250If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14251independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14252when we try to allocate a new one.
14253
14254The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14255
14256It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14257"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14258for more details.
14259
14260When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14261replaced by "<CACHE>".
14262
14263
142646.1. Limitation
14265----------------
14266
14267The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14268
14269- If the response is not a 200
14270- If the response contains a Vary header
14271- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14272- If the response is not cacheable
14273
14274- If the request is not a GET
14275- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14276- If the request contains an Authorization header
14277
14278
142796.2. Setup
14280-----------
14281
14282To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14283the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14284
14285
142866.2.1. Cache section
14287---------------------
14288
14289cache <name>
14290 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14291 size of cache is mandatory.
14292
14293total-max-size <megabytes>
14294 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14295 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14296
14297max-object-size <bytes>
14298 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14299 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14300 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14301
14302max-age <seconds>
14303 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14304 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14305 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14306 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14307 default.
14308
14309
143106.2.2. Proxy section
14311---------------------
14312
14313http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14314 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14315 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14316 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14317 after this one.
14318
14319http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14320 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14321 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14322 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14323 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14324
14325
14326Example:
14327
14328 backend bck1
14329 mode http
14330
14331 http-request cache-use foobar
14332 http-response cache-store foobar
14333 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14334
14335 cache foobar
14336 total-max-size 4
14337 max-age 240
14338
14339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143407. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14341----------------------------------
14342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014343HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014344client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14345The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14346these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14347but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14348data called patterns.
14349
14350
143517.1. ACL basics
14352---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014353
14354The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14355content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14356from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14357simple :
14358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014359 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014360 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014361 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14362 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014364The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14365adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014366
14367In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014370
14371This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14372Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14373and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014374an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14375conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14376as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14377are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014378
14379ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14380'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14381which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14382
14383There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14384performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14387specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14388this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014389methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14390ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391
14392Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14393 - boolean
14394 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14395 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14396 - string
14397 - data block
14398
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014399Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14400converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14401would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14402The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14403which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14404
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014405Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14406keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14407fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14408which are summarized in the table below :
14409
14410 +---------------------+-----------------+
14411 | Sample or converter | Default |
14412 | output type | matching method |
14413 +---------------------+-----------------+
14414 | boolean | bool |
14415 +---------------------+-----------------+
14416 | integer | int |
14417 +---------------------+-----------------+
14418 | ip | ip |
14419 +---------------------+-----------------+
14420 | string | str |
14421 +---------------------+-----------------+
14422 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14423 +---------------------+-----------------+
14424
14425Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14426matching method, see below.
14427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14429 - boolean
14430 - integer or integer range
14431 - IP address / network
14432 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14433 - regular expression
14434 - hex block
14435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014436The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14437
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014438 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14439 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014441 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014442 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014443 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014444 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14447read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14448if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14449lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14450will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14451beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14452a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14453lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14454exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14455
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014456The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14457parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14458ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14459a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14460check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14461
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014462The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14463socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14464file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14467loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14468
14469 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14470
14471In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14472the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14473case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14474as well.
14475
14476The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14477sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14478do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14479methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14480is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014481obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14483default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14484that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14485string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14486
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014487The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14488By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14489string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14490resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14491server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014492waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014493flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14494function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14497sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14498be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014499
14500 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14501 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014502 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14503 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14504 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14505 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014506
14507 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14508 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014510
14511 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014513
14514 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014516
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014517 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014518 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14519
14520 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14521 binary or string samples.
14522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014523 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14524 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14527 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14528 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14531 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14534 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014536 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14537 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14540 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014541 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14544 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14545 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014546
14547For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14548request, it is possible to do :
14549
14550 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14551
14552In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14553buffer, one would use the following acl :
14554
14555 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14556
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014557On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14558possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14559
14560 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14563criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14564method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14565to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14566criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14567the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014570the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14571For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014573 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14574 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14575 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14576 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014577
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014578
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014579The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14580types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14581combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14582brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14583default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014585 +-------------------------------------------------+
14586 | Input sample type |
14587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014588 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14590 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14591 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014592 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014594 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014596 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014597 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014598 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014600 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014602 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014604 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014606 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014607 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014608 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014610 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014611 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014612 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14614 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14615 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014616
14617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146187.1.1. Matching booleans
14619------------------------
14620
14621In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14622Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14623When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14624that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14625
14626Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14627return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14628"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146317.1.2. Matching integers
14632------------------------
14633
14634Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14635enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14636to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14637
14638Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14639matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14640lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014641
14642For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14643unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14644representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14645
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014646As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14647two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14648instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14649ranges and operators.
14650
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014651For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014652operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14653Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14654of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014655
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014656Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014657
14658 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14659 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14660 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14661 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14662 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014664For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014665
14666 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14667
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014668This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14669
14670 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146737.1.3. Matching strings
14674-----------------------
14675
14676String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14677different forms :
14678
14679 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014680 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014681
14682 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014683 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014684
14685 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14686 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14687
14688 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14689 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14690
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014691 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014692 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14693 matches.
14694
14695 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14696 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14697 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014698
14699String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14700exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14701characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14702string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14703to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014704before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014705
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014706Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14707(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14708Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14709
14710Example:
14711 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14712 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147157.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14716---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014717
14718Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14719they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14720possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14721passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14722the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014723the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14724match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014725
14726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147277.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14728-------------------------------------
14729
14730It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14731not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14732a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14733to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14734digits may be used upper or lower case.
14735
14736Example :
14737 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14738 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14739
14740
147417.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14742---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014743
14744IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14745netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14746within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014747host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014748difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14749at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14750does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14751parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014752
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014753The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14754abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14755
14756 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14757 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14758 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14759 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14760 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14761 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14762 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14763 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14764
14765Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14766192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14767
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014768IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14769Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14770trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14771IPv6 patterns.
14772
14773HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14774following situations :
14775 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14776 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14777 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14778 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14779 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14780 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14781 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14782 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14783 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14784 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786
147877.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14788----------------------------------
14789
14790Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14791combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14792
14793 - AND (implicit)
14794 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14795 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014799 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14802indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14805"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14806requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14807is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14808
14809 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014810 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14811 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14812 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813
14814To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14815and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14816
14817 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14818 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14819 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14820 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14821
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014822 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014823 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14824 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14825 use_backend www if host_www
14826
14827It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14828expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14829be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14830the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14831
14832 The following rule :
14833
14834 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014835 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836
14837 Can also be written that way :
14838
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014839 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840
14841It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14842to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14843simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14844sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14845good use is the following :
14846
14847 With named ACLs :
14848
14849 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14850 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14851 monitor fail if site_dead
14852
14853 With anonymous ACLs :
14854
14855 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14856
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014857See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14858keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014859
14860
148617.3. Fetching samples
14862---------------------
14863
14864Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14865against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14866sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14867ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14868of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14869available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14870
14871This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14872Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14873compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14874deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14875
14876The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14877matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14878method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14879indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14880
14881As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14882when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14883mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14884the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14885ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14886
14887Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14888multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14889when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014890incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14891are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14893all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14894
14895Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14896 - name
14897 - name(arg1)
14898 - name(arg1,arg2)
14899
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014900
149017.3.1. Converters
14902-----------------
14903
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014904Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14905of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14906is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14907was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014908has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014909unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14910
14911These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14912sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14913the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014914support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014915
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014916A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14917support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14918supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14919(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14920bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014923
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001492451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14925 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14926 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14927 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14928 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14929 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14930
14931 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014932 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14933 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014934 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14935 frontend http-in
14936 bind *:8081
14937 default_backend servers
14938 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14939 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14940
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014941add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014942 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014943 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014944 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14945 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014946 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014947 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14948 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14949 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014952 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014953
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014954aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14955 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14956 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14957 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14958 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14959 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14960 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14961
14962 Example:
14963 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14964 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14965
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014966and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014967 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014968 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014969 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14970 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014971 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014972 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14973 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14974 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14975 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014976 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014977 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014978
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014979b64dec
14980 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14981 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14982
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014983base64
14984 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014985 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014986 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14987
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014988bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014989 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014990 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014991 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014992 presence of a flag).
14993
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014994bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14995 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14996 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014997 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014998
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014999concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15000 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15001 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15002 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15003 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15004 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15005 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15006 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15007 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15008 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15009 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015010 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015011 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015012 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15013 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015014
15015 Example:
15016 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15017 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15018 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015019 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015020 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15021
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015022cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015023 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15024 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015025
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015026crc32([<avalanche>])
15027 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15028 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15029 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15030 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15031 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15032 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15033 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15034 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15035 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15036 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015037 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15038
15039crc32c([<avalanche>])
15040 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15041 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15042 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15043 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15044 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15045 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15046 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15047 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015048
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015049cut_crlf
15050 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15051 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15052 updated.
15053
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015054da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015055 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15056 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15057 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15058 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015059 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015060 configuration language.
15061
15062 Example:
15063 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015064 bind *:8881
15065 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015066 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015067
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015068debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15069 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15070 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15071 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15072 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15073 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15074 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15075 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15076 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15077 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15078 printable sample types.
15079
15080 Example:
15081 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015082
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015083digest(<algorithm>)
15084 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15085 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15086
15087 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15088 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15089
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015090div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015091 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15092 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015093 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015094 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15095 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015096 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015097 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15098 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15099 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15100 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015101 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015102 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015103
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015104djb2([<avalanche>])
15105 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15106 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15107 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15108 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15109 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15110 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15111 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015112 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15113 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015114
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015115even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015116 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015117 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15118
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015119field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15120 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15121 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15122 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15123 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15124 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15125 fields.
15126
15127 Example :
15128 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15129 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15130 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15131 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15132 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015133
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015134hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015135 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015136 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015137 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015138 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015139
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015140hex2i
15141 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015142 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015143
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015144htonl
15145 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15146 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15147 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15148 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15149
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015150hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15151 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15152 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15153 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15154 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15155
15156 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15157 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15158
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015159http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015160 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15161 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015162 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15163 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15164 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15165 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15166 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15167 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15168 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15169 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015171iif(<true>,<false>)
15172 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15173 string otherwise.
15174
15175 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015176 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015177
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015178in_table(<table>)
15179 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15180 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15181 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015182 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015183 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15184
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015185ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15186 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015187 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015188 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15189 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15190 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15191 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15192 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015193
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015194json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015195 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015196 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015197 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015198 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15199 of errors:
15200 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15201 bytes, ...)
15202 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15203 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15204
15205 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15206 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15207 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15208 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15209 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15210 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015211 - "ascii" : never fails;
15212 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15213 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015214 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015215 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015216 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15217 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15218
15219 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015220 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015221
15222 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015223 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015224 capture request header user-agent len 150
15225 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015226
15227 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15228 GET / HTTP/1.0
15229 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15230
15231 Output log:
15232 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15233
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015234language(<value>[,<default>])
15235 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15236 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15237 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15238 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15239 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15240 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15241 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15242 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15243 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015244 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015245 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15246 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015247
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015248 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015249
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015250 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15251 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015252
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015253 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15254 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15255 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15256 use_backend spanish if es
15257 use_backend french if fr
15258 use_backend english if en
15259 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015260
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015261length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015262 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15263 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15264 type. The result is of type integer.
15265
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015266lower
15267 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15268 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15269 type. The result is of type string.
15270
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015271ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15272 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15273 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15274 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15275 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15276 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15277 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15278
15279 Example :
15280
15281 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015282 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015283 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15284
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015285ltrim(<chars>)
15286 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15287 representation of the input sample.
15288
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015289map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15290map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15291map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15292 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15293 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15294 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15295 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15296 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15297 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15298 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15299 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015300
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015301 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15302 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15303 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015304
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015305 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015306 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015307
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015308 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15309 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15310 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15311 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015312 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15313 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015314 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15315 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15316 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15317 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15318 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15319 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15320 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15321 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015322 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15323 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15324 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015325 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15326 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15327 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15328 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15329 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015330
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015331 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15332 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15333 the corresponding match text.
15334
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015335 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15336 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15337 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15338 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15339 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015340
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015341 Example :
15342
15343 # this is a comment and is ignored
15344 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15345 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15346 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15347 | | | `---------- value
15348 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15349 | `---------------------------- key
15350 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15351
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015352mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015353 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15354 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015355 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015356 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015357 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015358 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15359 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15360 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15361 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015362 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015363 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015364
15365mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015366 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015367 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15368 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015369 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015370 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015371 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015372 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15373 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015378
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015379nbsrv
15380 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15381 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15382 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15383 map lookup.
15384
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015385neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015386 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15387 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15388 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15389 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015390
15391not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015392 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015393 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015394 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015395 absence of a flag).
15396
15397odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015398 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015399 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15400
15401or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015402 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015403 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015404 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15405 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015406 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015407 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15408 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15409 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15410 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015411 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015412 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015413
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015414protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15415 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15416 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15417 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15418 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15419 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15420 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15421 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15422 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15423 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15424 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15425 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15426
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015427regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015428 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15429 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15430 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15431 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15432 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15433 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15434 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15435 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15436 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015437 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15438 of characters with other ones.
15439
15440 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15441 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15442 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15443 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15444 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15445 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015446
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015447 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015448
15449 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15450 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15451 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015452 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015453
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015454 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15455 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15456
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015457 # capture groups and backreferences
15458 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015459 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015460 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15461
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015462capture-req(<id>)
15463 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15464 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15465
15466 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015467 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15468 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015469
15470capture-res(<id>)
15471 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15472 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15473
15474 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015475 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15476 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015477
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015478rtrim(<chars>)
15479 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15480 of the input sample.
15481
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015482sdbm([<avalanche>])
15483 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15484 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15485 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15486 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15487 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15488 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15489 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015490 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15491 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015492
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015493secure_memcmp(<var>)
15494 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15495 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15496 match.
15497
15498 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15499 performed in constant time.
15500
15501 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15502 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15503
15504 Example :
15505
15506 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15507 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15508 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15509 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15510
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015511set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015512 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15513 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15514 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015515 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015516 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15517 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015518 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015519 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15520 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015521 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015522 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015523
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015524sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015525 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015526 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15527
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015528sha2([<bits>])
15529 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15530 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15531
15532 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15533 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15534
15535 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15536 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15537
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015538srv_queue
15539 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15540 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15541 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15542 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15543 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15544
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015545strcmp(<var>)
15546 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15547 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15548 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15549 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15550 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15551 shorter).
15552
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015553 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15554 strings in constant time.
15555
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015556 Example :
15557
15558 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15559 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15560 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15561
15562
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015563sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015564 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15565 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015566 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015567 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15568 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015569 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015570 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15571 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015572 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015573 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15574 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015575 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015576 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015577
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015578table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15579 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15580 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15581 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15582 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15583 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15584 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15585
15586
15587table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15588 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15589 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15590 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15591 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15592 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15593 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15594
15595table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15596 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15597 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015598 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015599 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15600 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15601
15602table_conn_cur(<table>)
15603 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15604 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15605 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15606 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15607 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15608
15609table_conn_rate(<table>)
15610 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15611 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15612 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15613 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15614 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15615
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015616table_gpt0(<table>)
15617 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15618 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15619 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15620 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15621 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15622
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015623table_gpc0(<table>)
15624 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15625 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15626 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15627 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15628 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15629
15630table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15631 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15632 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15633 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15634 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15635 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15636 sample fetch keyword.
15637
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015638table_gpc1(<table>)
15639 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15640 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15641 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15642 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15643 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15644
15645table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15646 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15647 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15648 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15649 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15650 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15651 sample fetch keyword.
15652
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015653table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15654 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15655 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015656 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015657 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15658 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15659
15660table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15661 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15662 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15663 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15664 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15665 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15666 keyword.
15667
15668table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015671 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015672 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15673 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15674
15675table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15676 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15677 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15678 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15679 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15680 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15681 keyword.
15682
15683table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015686 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015687 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15688 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15689 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15690 keyword.
15691
15692table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015696 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15697 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15698 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15699 keyword.
15700
15701table_server_id(<table>)
15702 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15703 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15704 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15705 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15706 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15707 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15708
15709table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15710 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15711 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015712 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015713 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15714 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15715 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15716 keyword.
15717
15718table_sess_rate(<table>)
15719 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15720 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15721 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15722 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15723 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15724 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15725 keyword.
15726
15727table_trackers(<table>)
15728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15731 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15732 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15733 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15734 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15735 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15736 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15737 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15738
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015739upper
15740 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15741 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15742 type. The result is of type string.
15743
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015744url_dec([<in_form>])
15745 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15746 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15747 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15748 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15749 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15750 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015751
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015752ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015753 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015754 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15755 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15756 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015757 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15758 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15759 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15760 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015761 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015762 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15763 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015764
15765 Example:
15766 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15767 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15768
15769 message Point {
15770 int32 latitude = 1;
15771 int32 longitude = 2;
15772 }
15773
15774 message PPoint {
15775 Point point = 59;
15776 }
15777
15778 message Rectangle {
15779 // One corner of the rectangle.
15780 PPoint lo = 48;
15781 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15782 PPoint hi = 49;
15783 }
15784
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015785 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15786 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15787 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015788
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015789 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15790 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015791 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015792 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15793
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015794 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015795
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015796 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015797
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015798 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15799 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15800 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015801
15802 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15803 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15804 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15805
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015806 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15807 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15808 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015809
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015810
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015811unset-var(<var name>)
15812 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15813 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15814 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15815 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15816 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15817 response),
15818 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15819 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15820 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15821 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15822
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015823utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15824 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15825 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15826 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15827 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15828 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15829 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15830
15831 Example :
15832
15833 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015834 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015835 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15836
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015837word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15838 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15839 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15840 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015841 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015842 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15843 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15844
15845 Example :
15846 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15847 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15848 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15849 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15850 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015851 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015852
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015853wt6([<avalanche>])
15854 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15855 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15856 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15857 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15858 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15859 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15860 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015861 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15862 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015863
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015864xor(<value>)
15865 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015866 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015867 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015868 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015869 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015870 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15871 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015872 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015873 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15874 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015875 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015876 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015877
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015878xxh32([<seed>])
15879 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15880 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15881 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15882 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15883 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15884 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15885 as cryptographically secure.
15886
15887xxh64([<seed>])
15888 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15889 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15890 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15891 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15892 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15893 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15894 as cryptographically secure.
15895
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015896
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158977.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898--------------------------------------------
15899
15900A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15901not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15902"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15903The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15904
15905always_false : boolean
15906 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15907 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15908
15909always_true : boolean
15910 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15911 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15912
15913avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015914 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15916 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15917 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15918 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15919 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15920 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15921 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15922 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15923 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15924 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15925 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15926 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15927 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015930 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15931 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15932 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15933 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015934 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15935
15936be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15937 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15938 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15939 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15940 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15941 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015942 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15943 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015944
15945 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15946 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15947 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15950 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15951 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15952 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015953 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15955 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015956
15957 Example :
15958 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15959 backend dynamic
15960 mode http
15961 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15962 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015963
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015964bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015965 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15966 of the string.
15967
15968bool(<bool>) : bool
15969 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15970 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15973 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015974 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15976 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015977
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015978 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015979 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015980 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15981
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015982 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15983 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015984
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015985 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015986 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015988 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015989 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015991 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015992
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015993 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15994 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015996 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015997
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015998cpu_calls : integer
15999 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16000 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16001 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16002 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16003 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16004 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16005
16006cpu_ns_avg : integer
16007 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16008 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16009 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16010 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16011 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16012 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16013 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16014 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16015 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16016 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16017 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16018
16019cpu_ns_tot : integer
16020 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16021 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16022 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16023 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16024 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16025 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16026 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16027 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16028 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16029 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16030 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16031 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16032 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16033
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016034date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016035 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016036
16037 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16038 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16039 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016040 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16041
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016042 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16043 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16044 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16045 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16046 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16047
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016048 Example :
16049
16050 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16051 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016052
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016053 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16054 # millisecond granularity
16055 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16056
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016057date_us : integer
16058 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16059 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16060 from the same timeval structure.
16061
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016062distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16063 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16064 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16065 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16066 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16067 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16068 list of supported tokens.
16069
16070distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16071 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16072 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16073 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16074 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16075 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16076 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16077 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16078 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16079 supported tokens.
16080
16081 Example :
16082 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16083 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16084 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16085 # send large files to the big farm
16086 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16087
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016088env(<name>) : string
16089 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16090 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16091 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16092 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16093 certain way.
16094
16095 Examples :
16096 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16097 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16098
16099 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16100 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16103 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016104 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16105 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16107 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016108 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16110 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016111
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016112fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16114 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16115 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16119 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16120 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16121 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16122 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16123 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16124 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16125 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016126
16127 Example :
16128 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16129 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16130 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16131 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16132 frontend mail
16133 bind :25
16134 mode tcp
16135 maxconn 100
16136 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16137 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16138 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16139 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016140
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016141hostname : string
16142 Returns the system hostname.
16143
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016144int(<integer>) : signed integer
16145 Returns a signed integer.
16146
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016147ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16148 Returns an ipv4.
16149
16150ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16151 Returns an ipv6.
16152
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016153lat_ns_avg : integer
16154 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16155 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16156 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16157 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16158 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16159 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16160 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16161 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16162 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016163 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16164 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16165 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16166 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16167 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16168 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016169
16170lat_ns_tot : integer
16171 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16172 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16173 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16174 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16175 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16176 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16177 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16178 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16179 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016180 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16181 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16182 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16183 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16184 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016185 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16186 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16187 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16188 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16189 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16190 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16191
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016192meth(<method>) : method
16193 Returns a method.
16194
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016195nbproc : integer
16196 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16197 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16198 and debugging purposes.
16199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16201 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16202 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16203 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016204 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16205 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16206 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016207
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016208prio_class : integer
16209 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16210 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16211 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16212
16213prio_offset : integer
16214 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16215 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16216 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16217 set-priority-offset".
16218
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016219proc : integer
16220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16221 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16222 debugging purposes.
16223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016224queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016225 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16226 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16227 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16229 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16230 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16231 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16232 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16233
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016234rand([<range>]) : integer
16235 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16236 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16237 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16238 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16239 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16240
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016241uuid([<version>]) : string
16242 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16243 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16244 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16247 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16248 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16249 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16250 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16251 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016252 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16253 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16254
16255srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16256 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16257 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16258 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16259 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16260 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16261 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16262 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16263
16264 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16265 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266
16267srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16268 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16269 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16270 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016271 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16273 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16274 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16275
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016276srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16277 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16278 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16279 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16280 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16281 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16282 fetch methods.
16283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016284srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16285 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16286 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016287 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016288 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16289 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016290 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291 overloading servers).
16292
16293 Example :
16294 # Redirect to a separate back
16295 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16296 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16297 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16298
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016299srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16300 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16301 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16302 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16303
16304srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16305 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16306 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16307 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16308
16309srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16310 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16311 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16312 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16313
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016314stopping : boolean
16315 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16316 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16317 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16318
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016319str(<string>) : string
16320 Returns a string.
16321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016322table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16323 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16324 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16325
16326table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16327 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16328 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16329 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16330
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016331thread : integer
16332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16333 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16334 and debugging purposes.
16335
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016336var(<var-name>) : undefined
16337 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016338 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16339 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016340 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016341 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16342 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016343 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016344 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16345 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016346 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016347 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016348
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163497.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016350----------------------------------
16351
16352The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16353closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16354methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16355sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16356TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016357the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16358counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016359"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16360used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16361can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16362Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16363table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16364tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16365currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016366
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016367bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016368 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16369 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16370 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372be_id : integer
16373 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016374 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16375 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016377be_name : string
16378 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016379 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16380 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016382dst : ip
16383 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16384 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16385 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16386 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016387 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16388 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16389 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16390 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16391 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16392 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016393
16394dst_conn : integer
16395 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16396 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16397 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16398 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16399 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16400 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16401 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16402 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016403
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016404dst_is_local : boolean
16405 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16406 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16407 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16408 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016409 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016410 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16411 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16412 it only once per connection.
16413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016414dst_port : integer
16415 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16416 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16417 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16418 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16419 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16420 an HTTP header.
16421
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016422fc_http_major : integer
16423 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16424 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16425 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16426
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016427fc_pp_authority : string
16428 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16429 if any.
16430
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016431fc_pp_unique_id : string
16432 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16433 if any.
16434
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016435fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16436 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16437 header.
16438
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016439fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16440 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16441 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16442 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16443 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16444 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16445 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16446
16447fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16448 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16449 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16450 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16451 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16452 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16453 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16454
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016455fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016456 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16457 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16458 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16459 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16460
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016461fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016462 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16463 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16464 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16465 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16466
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016467fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016468 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16469 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16470 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16471 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16472
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016473fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016474 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16475 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16476 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16477 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16478
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016479fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016480 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16481 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16482 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16483 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16484
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016485fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016486 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16487 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16488 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16489 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16490
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016491fe_defbe : string
16492 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16493 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016495fe_id : integer
16496 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016497 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016498 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16499
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016500fe_name : string
16501 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16502 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16503 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16504
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016505sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016506sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16507sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16508sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016509 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16510 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16511 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16512
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016513sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016514sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16515sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16516sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016517 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16518 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16519 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16520
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016521sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016522sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16523sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16524sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016525 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16526 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016527 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16528 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16529 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016530
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016531 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016532 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16533 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016534 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16535 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16536 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016537 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16538 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16539
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016540sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16541sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16542sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16543sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16544 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16545 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16546 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16547 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16548 when a first ACL was verified.
16549
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016550sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016551sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16552sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16553sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016554 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016555 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016557sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016558sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16559sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16560sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016561 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16562 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16563 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16564
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016565sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016566sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16567sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16568sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016569 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16570 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16571 See also src_conn_rate.
16572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016573sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016574sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16575sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16576sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016577 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016578 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016579
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016580sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16581sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16582sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16583sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16584 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16585 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16586
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016587sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16588sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16589sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16590sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16591 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16592 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16593
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016594sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016595sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16596sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16597sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016598 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16599 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16600 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016601 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16602 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16603 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016604
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016605sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16606sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16607sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16608sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16609 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16610 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16611 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16612 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16613 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16614 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016616sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016617sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16618sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16619sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016620 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016621 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16622 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16623
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016624sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016625sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16626sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16627sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016628 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16629 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16630 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16631 src_http_err_rate.
16632
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016633sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016634sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16635sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16636sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016637 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016638 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16639 src_http_req_cnt.
16640
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016641sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016642sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16643sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16644sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016645 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16646 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16647 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16648 src_http_req_rate.
16649
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016650sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016651sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16652sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16653sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016654 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016655 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16656 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16657 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16658 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016659
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016660 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016661 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16662 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016663 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16664
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016665sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16666sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16667sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16668sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16669 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16670 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16671 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16672 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16673 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16674
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016675sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016676sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16677sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16678sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016679 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16680 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16681 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016682
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016683sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016684sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16685sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16686sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016687 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16688 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16689 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016691sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016692sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16693sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16694sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016695 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016696 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16697 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16698 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016699 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016700 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16701
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016702sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016703sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16704sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16705sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016706 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16707 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16708 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16709 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16710 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016711 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016712
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016713sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016714sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16715sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16716sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016717 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16718 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16719 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16720
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016721sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016722sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16723sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16724sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016725 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16726 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016727 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016728 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16729 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16731 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16732 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016734so_id : integer
16735 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16736 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16737 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016738
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016739so_name : string
16740 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16741 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16742 strings instead of integers.
16743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016744src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016745 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016746 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16747 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16748 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016749 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16750 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16751 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016752 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16753 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16754 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16755 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16756 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16757 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16758 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016759
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016760 Example:
16761 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16762 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16765 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16766 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16767 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016768 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16771 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16772 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016773 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016774 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16777 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16778 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16779 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16780 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16781 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16782 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016783
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016784 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016785 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16786 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16787 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16788 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016789 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016790 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16791 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16792
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016793src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16794 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16795 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16796 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16797 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16798 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16799 was verified.
16800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016802 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016804 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016805 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016808 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016809 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16810 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016811 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16814 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16815 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16816 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016817 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016820 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016822 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016823 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016824
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016825src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16826 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16827 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16828 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16829 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16830
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016831src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16832 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16833 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16834 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16835 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016837src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016838 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016840 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16841 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016842 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16843 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16844 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016845
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016846src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16847 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16848 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16849 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16850 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16851 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16852 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16853 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016856 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016857 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016858 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016859 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016860 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16863 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16864 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16865 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16866 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016867 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016870 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16872 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016873 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16876 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16877 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16878 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016879 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016880 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16883 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16884 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16885 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016886 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016887 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16888 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016889
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016890 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016891 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016892 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016893 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016894
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016895src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16896 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16897 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16898 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16899 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16900 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16901 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16902
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016903src_is_local : boolean
16904 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16905 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16906 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16907 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016908 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016909 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16910 once per connection.
16911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016912src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016913 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16914 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16915 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16916 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16917 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016919src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016920 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16921 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16922 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16923 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16924 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926src_port : integer
16927 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16928 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16929 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16930 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016932src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016933 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016934 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16935 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16936 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016937 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16940 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16941 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16942 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16943 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016944 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16947 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16948 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16949 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16950 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16951 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16952 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16953 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16954 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016955
16956 Example :
16957 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16958 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16959 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16960 listen ssh
16961 bind :22
16962 mode tcp
16963 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016964 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016965 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016966 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016968srv_id : integer
16969 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16970 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016971 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016972
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016973srv_name : string
16974 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16975 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016976 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016977
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169787.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016979----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016981The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16982closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16983when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16984usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016985future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016986
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001698751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16988 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16989 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16990 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16991 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16992 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16993
16994 Example :
16995 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16996 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16997 # the request.
16998 frontend http-in
16999 bind *:8081
17000 default_backend servers
17001 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17002 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17003
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017004ssl_bc : boolean
17005 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17006 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017007 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17008 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017009
17010ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17011 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017012 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17013 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017014
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017015ssl_bc_alpn : string
17016 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17017 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017018 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017019 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17020 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17021 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17022 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17023 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017024 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17025 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017026
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017027ssl_bc_cipher : string
17028 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017029 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17030 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017031
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017032ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17033 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17034 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17035 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017036 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017037
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017038ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17039 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17040 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017041 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17042 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017043
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017044ssl_bc_npn : string
17045 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17046 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017047 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017048 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17049 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17050 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17051 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017052 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17053 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017054
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017055ssl_bc_protocol : string
17056 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017057 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17058 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017059
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017060ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017061 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017062 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017063 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17064 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017065
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017066ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17067 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17068 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17069 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017070 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017071
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017072ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17073 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17074 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017075 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17076 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017077
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017078ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17079 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17080 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17081 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017082 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017083
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017084ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17085 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017086 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17087 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017089ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17090 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17091 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17092 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17093 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17094 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17097 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17098 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17099 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17100 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017101
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017102ssl_c_der : binary
17103 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17104 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17105 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17106
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017107ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17108 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17109 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17110 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17111 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17112 does not support resumed sessions.
17113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114ssl_c_err : integer
17115 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17116 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17117 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17118 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17119 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017120
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017121ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017122 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17123 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17124 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17125 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17126 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17127 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17128 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17129 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017130 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17131 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17132 LDAP v3.
17133 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17134 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017136ssl_c_key_alg : string
17137 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17138 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17139 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017141ssl_c_notafter : string
17142 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17143 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17144 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146ssl_c_notbefore : string
17147 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17148 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17149 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017150
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017151ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017152 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17153 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17154 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17155 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17156 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17157 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17158 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17159 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017160 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17161 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17162 LDAP v3.
17163 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17164 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017166ssl_c_serial : binary
17167 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17168 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17169 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17172 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17173 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17174 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017175 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17176 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17177
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017178 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017179 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17182 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17183 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17184 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017186ssl_c_used : boolean
17187 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17188 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190ssl_c_verify : integer
17191 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17192 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17193 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17194 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017196ssl_c_version : integer
17197 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17198 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017199
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017200ssl_f_der : binary
17201 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17202 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17203 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17204
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017205ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017206 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17207 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17208 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17209 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017210 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017211 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17212 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17213 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017214 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17215 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17216 LDAP v3.
17217 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17218 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017220ssl_f_key_alg : string
17221 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17222 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17223 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017225ssl_f_notafter : string
17226 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17227 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17228 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017230ssl_f_notbefore : string
17231 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17232 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17233 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017234
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017235ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017236 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17237 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17238 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17239 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17240 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17241 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17242 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17243 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017244 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17245 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17246 LDAP v3.
17247 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17248 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017250ssl_f_serial : binary
17251 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17252 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17253 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017254
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017255ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17256 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17257 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17258 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017260ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17261 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17262 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17263 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265ssl_f_version : integer
17266 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17267 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17268
17269ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017270 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17271 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17272 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017274 Example :
17275 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17276 listen http-https
17277 bind :80
17278 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17279 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17280
17281ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17282 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17283 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17284
17285ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017286 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17288 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17289 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17290 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17291 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17292 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17293 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17294 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017296ssl_fc_cipher : string
17297 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17298 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017299
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017300ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17301 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17302 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017303 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017304
17305ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17306 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17307 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017308 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017309
17310ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17311 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17312 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17313 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017314 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017315 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017316
17317ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17318 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17319 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017320 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017321
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017322ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17323 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17324 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17325 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17326
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017327ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17328 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17329 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17330 transport layer.
17331 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17332 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17333 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17334 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17335
17336ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17337 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17338 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17339 transport layer.
17340 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17341 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17342 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17343 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17344
17345ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17346 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17347 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17348 transport layer.
17349 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17350 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17351 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17352 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17353
17354ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17355 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17356 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17357 transport layer.
17358 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17359 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17360 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17361 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17362
17363ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17364 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17365 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17366 transport layer.
17367 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17368 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17369 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17370 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017372ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017373 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17374 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017375 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17376 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17377 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17378 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017379
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017380ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17381 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17382 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17383 wait until the handshake happened.
17384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017385ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17386 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017387 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17388 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017389 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017390 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017391
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017392ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017393 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017394 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17395 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017398 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17400 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17401 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17402 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17403 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17404 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17405 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407ssl_fc_protocol : string
17408 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17409 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017410
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017411ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017412 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017413 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17414 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017415
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017416ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17417 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17418 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17419 transport layer.
17420 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17421 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17422 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17423 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17424
17425ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17426 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17427 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17428 transport layer.
17429 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17430 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17431 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17432 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17433
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017434ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17435 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17436 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17437 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17440 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17441 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17442 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17443 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017444
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017445ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17446 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17447 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17448 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17449 BoringSSL.
17450
17451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017452ssl_fc_sni : string
17453 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17454 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17455 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17456 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17457 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17458
17459 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17460 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17461 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017462 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017463 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017465 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017466 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17467 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017469ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17470 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17471 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017472
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017473ssl_s_der : binary
17474 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17475 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17476 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17477
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017478ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17479 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17480 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17481 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17482 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17483 does not support resumed sessions.
17484
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017485ssl_s_key_alg : string
17486 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17487 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17488 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17489
17490ssl_s_notafter : string
17491 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17492 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17493 transport layer.
17494
17495ssl_s_notbefore : string
17496 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17497 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17498 transport layer.
17499
17500ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17501 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17502 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17503 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17504 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17505 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17506 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017507 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17508 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017509 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17510 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17511 LDAP v3.
17512 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17513 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17514
17515ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17516 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17517 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17518 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17519 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17520 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17521 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017522 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17523 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017524 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17525 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17526 LDAP v3.
17527 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17528 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17529
17530ssl_s_serial : binary
17531 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17532 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17533 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17534
17535ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17536 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17537 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17538 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17539
17540ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17541 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17542 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17543 layer.
17544
17545ssl_s_version : integer
17546 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17547 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175497.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017550------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017552Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17553sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17554only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17555For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17556be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17557can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17558sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17559for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17560content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017563 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017564 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17565 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017567payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17568 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017569 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017571
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017572req.hdrs : string
17573 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17574 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17575 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17576 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17577
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017578req.hdrs_bin : binary
17579 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17580 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17581 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17582 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17583 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17584 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17585
17586 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17587
17588 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17589 str: <int:length><bytes>
17590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017591req.len : integer
17592req_len : integer (deprecated)
17593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17594 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17595 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17596 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17597 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17598 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17599 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17600 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017602req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17603 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017604 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17605 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17606 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17607 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017609 ACL alternatives :
17610 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017612req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17613 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17614 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17615 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17616 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017618 ACL alternatives :
17619 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017623req.proto_http : boolean
17624req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17625 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17626 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17627 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17628 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17629 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17630 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17631 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017633 Example:
17634 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17635 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17636 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017637 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017639req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17640rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17641 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17642 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17643 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17644 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17645 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17646 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17647 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017649 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17650 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17651 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17652 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17653 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17654 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017656 ACL derivatives :
17657 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659 Example :
17660 listen tse-farm
17661 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17662 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17663 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17664 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17665 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17666 persist rdp-cookie
17667 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17668 # This is only useful makes sense if
17669 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17670 stick-table type string size 204800
17671 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17672 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17673 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17676 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017678req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17679rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17680 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17681 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17682 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17683 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685 ACL derivatives :
17686 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017687
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017688req.ssl_alpn : string
17689 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17690 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17691 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17692 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17693 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17694 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017695 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017696
17697 Examples :
17698 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17699 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17700 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017701 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017702 default_backend bk_default
17703
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017704req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17705 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17706 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017707 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17708 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17709 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17710 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17711 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17714req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17715 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17716 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17717 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17718 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17719 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17720 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17721 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723req.ssl_sni : string
17724req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17725 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17726 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17727 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17728 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17729 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017730 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17731 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17732 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17733 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17734 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17735 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17736 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17737 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17738 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017740 ACL derivatives :
17741 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743 Examples :
17744 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17745 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17746 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17747 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17748 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017749
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017750req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17751 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17752 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17753 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17754 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17755 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17756 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17757 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17758 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17759 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017761req.ssl_ver : integer
17762req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17763 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17764 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17765 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17766 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17767 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17768 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17769 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017770 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017773 ACL derivatives :
17774 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017775
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017776res.len : integer
17777 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17778 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17779 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17780 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17781 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17782 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17783 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017784 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017786res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17787 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017788 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017789 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017790 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017791 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017793res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17794 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17795 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17796 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017797 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17798 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017800 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017801
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017802res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17803rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17804 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17805 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17806 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17807 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17808 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17809 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17810 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017812wait_end : boolean
17813 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17814 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017815 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17817 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017818 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17820 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017822 Examples :
17823 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17824 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17825 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17828 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17829 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17830 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17831 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17832 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17833 tcp-request content reject
17834
17835
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178367.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017837--------------------------------------
17838
17839It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17840This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17841data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17842its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17843HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17844content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17845to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17846more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17847response are indexed.
17848
17849base : string
17850 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17851 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17852 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17853 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17854 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17855 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17856 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17857 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17858
17859 ACL derivatives :
17860 base : exact string match
17861 base_beg : prefix match
17862 base_dir : subdir match
17863 base_dom : domain match
17864 base_end : suffix match
17865 base_len : length match
17866 base_reg : regex match
17867 base_sub : substring match
17868
17869base32 : integer
17870 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17871 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17872 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017873 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17874 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17875 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017876
17877base32+src : binary
17878 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17879 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17880 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17881 per-URL counters.
17882
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017883capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17884 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17885 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17886 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17887
17888capture.req.method : string
17889 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17890 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17891 because it's allocated.
17892
17893capture.req.uri : string
17894 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17895 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17896 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17897 allocated.
17898
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017899capture.req.ver : string
17900 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17901 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17902 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17903
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017904capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17905 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17906 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17907 The first entry is an index of 0.
17908 See also: "capture response header"
17909
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017910capture.res.ver : string
17911 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17912 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17913 persistent flag.
17914
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017915req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017916 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17917 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17918 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017919
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017920req.body_param([<name>) : string
17921 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17922 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17923 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17924 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17925 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17926 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17927 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17928 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17929 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17930 given.
17931
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017932req.body_len : integer
17933 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17934 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017935 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17936 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017937
17938req.body_size : integer
17939 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017940 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17941 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017943req.cook([<name>]) : string
17944cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17945 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17946 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17947 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17948 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17949 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17950 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17951 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17952 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17953
17954 ACL derivatives :
17955 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17956 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17957 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17958 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17959 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17960 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17961 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17962 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017964req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17965cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17966 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17967 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17970cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17971 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17972 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17973 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17974 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017976cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17977 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17978 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17979 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17980 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017981 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17983 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17984 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17985 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017987hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17988 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17989 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17990 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17991 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017992 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017994req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17995 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17996 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17997 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17998 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17999 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18000 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18001 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18002 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018004req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18005 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18006 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18007 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18008 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018010req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18011 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18012 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18013 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18014 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18015 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18016 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18017 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18018 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018019 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018021 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018023 ACL derivatives :
18024 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18025 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18026 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18027 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18028 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18029 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18030 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18031 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18032
18033req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18034hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18035 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18036 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18037 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18038 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18039 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18040 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18041 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18042 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18043 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18044
18045req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18046hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18047 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18048 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18049 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18050 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18051 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018052 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018053 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18054 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18055
18056req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18057hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18058 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18059 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18060 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18061 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18062 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18063 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18064 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18065
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018066
18067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018068http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18069 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18070 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18071 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18072 basic auth is supported.
18073
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018074http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18075 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18076 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18077 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18078 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018079 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18080 basic auth is supported.
18081
18082 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018083 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18084 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18085 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18086 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018087
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018088http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018089 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18090 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18091 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018092
18093http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018094 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18095 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18096 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018097
18098http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018099 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18100 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18101 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018103http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018104 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18105 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018106 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18107 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018109method : integer + string
18110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18111 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18112 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18113 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18114 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18115 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18116 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118 ACL derivatives :
18119 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018121 Example :
18122 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18123 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18124 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018126path : string
18127 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18128 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18129 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18130 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18131 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018132 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018135 ACL derivatives :
18136 path : exact string match
18137 path_beg : prefix match
18138 path_dir : subdir match
18139 path_dom : domain match
18140 path_end : suffix match
18141 path_len : length match
18142 path_reg : regex match
18143 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018144
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018145pathq : string
18146 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18147 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18148 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18149 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18150 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18151 result in both cases.
18152
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018153query : string
18154 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18155 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18156 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18157 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018158 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018159 which stops before the question mark.
18160
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018161req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18162 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18163 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18164 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18165 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167req.ver : string
18168req_ver : string (deprecated)
18169 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18170 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18171 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018173 ACL derivatives :
18174 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018175
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018176res.body : binary
18177 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18178 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18179 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18180 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18181
18182res.body_len : integer
18183 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18184 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18185 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18186 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18187
18188res.body_size : integer
18189 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18190 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18191 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18192 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18193 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18194 based expect rules.
18195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018196res.comp : boolean
18197 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18198 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18199 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018201res.comp_algo : string
18202 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18203 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18204 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018206res.cook([<name>]) : string
18207scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18208 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18209 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018210 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18211 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018213 ACL derivatives :
18214 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018216res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18217scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18218 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18219 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018220 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18221 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18224scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18225 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18226 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018227 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18228 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18231 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18232 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18233 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18234 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18235 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18236 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18237 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18238 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018239 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018241res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18242 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18243 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18244 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18245 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018246 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18247 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018249res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18250shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18251 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18252 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18253 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18254 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18255 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18256 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18257 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018258 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18259 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018261 ACL derivatives :
18262 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18263 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18264 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18265 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18266 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18267 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18268 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18269 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18270
18271res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18272shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18273 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18274 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18275 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18276 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018277 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18280shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18281 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18282 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18283 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18284 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18285 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018286 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18287 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018288
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018289res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18290 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18291 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18292 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018293 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18294 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018296res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18297shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18298 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18299 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18300 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18301 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18302 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018303 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18304 based expect rules.
18305
18306res.hdrs : string
18307 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18308 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18309 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18310 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18311 based expect rules.
18312
18313res.hdrs_bin : binary
18314 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18315 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18316 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18317 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18318 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18319 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18320 (length of 0 for both).
18321
18322 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18323
18324 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18325 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327res.ver : string
18328resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18329 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018330 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18331 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018333 ACL derivatives :
18334 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18337 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18338 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018339 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018340 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018342 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18343 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345status : integer
18346 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18347 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018348 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18349 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018350
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018351unique-id : string
18352 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18353 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18354 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18355 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18356 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18357 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018359url : string
18360 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18361 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18362 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18363 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18364 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18365 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18366 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368 ACL derivatives :
18369 url : exact string match
18370 url_beg : prefix match
18371 url_dir : subdir match
18372 url_dom : domain match
18373 url_end : suffix match
18374 url_len : length match
18375 url_reg : regex match
18376 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378url_ip : ip
18379 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18380 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18381 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18382 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18383 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18384 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18385 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018387url_port : integer
18388 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18389 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18390 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18391 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018392
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018393urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18394url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018395 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18396 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018397 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18398 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18399 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18400 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018401 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18402 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018403 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18404 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018406 ACL derivatives :
18407 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18408 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18409 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18410 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18411 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18412 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18413 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18414 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018415
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018417 Example :
18418 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18419 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18420 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18421 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018422
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018423urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18425 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18426 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018427
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018428url32 : integer
18429 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18430 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18431 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18432 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18433 is an unsigned integer.
18434
18435url32+src : binary
18436 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18437 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18438 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18439
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018440
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200184417.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018442---------------------------------------
18443
18444This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18445used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18446purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18447There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18448or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18449any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18450for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18451
18452internal.htx.data : integer
18453 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18454 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18455
18456internal.htx.free : integer
18457 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18458 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18459
18460internal.htx.free_data : integer
18461 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18462 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18463
18464internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18465 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18466 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18467 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18468
18469internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18470 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18471 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18472
18473internal.htx.size : integer
18474 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18475 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18476
18477internal.htx.used : integer
18478 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18479 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18480 direction.
18481
18482internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18483 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18484 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18485 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18486 of the special value :
18487 * head : The oldest inserted block
18488 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018489 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018490
18491internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18492 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18493 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18494 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18495 integer or one of the special value :
18496 * head : The oldest inserted block
18497 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018498 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018499
18500internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18501 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18502 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18503 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18504 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18505
18506 * head : The oldest inserted block
18507 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018508 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018509
18510internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18511 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18512 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18513 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18514 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18515
18516 * head : The oldest inserted block
18517 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018518 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018519
18520internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18521 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18522 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18523 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18524 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18525
18526 * head : The oldest inserted block
18527 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018528 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018529
18530internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18531 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18532 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18533 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18534 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18535
18536 * head : The oldest inserted block
18537 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018538 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018539
18540internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18541 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18542 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18543 it returns false.
18544
18545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200185467.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018547---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018549Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18550every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018551order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018553ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18554---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018555FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018556HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018557HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18558HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018559HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18560HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18561HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18562HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18563LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018564METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018565METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018566METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18567METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18568METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18569METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018570METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018571METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018572RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018573REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018574TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018575WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18576---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018577
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185798. Logging
18580----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018581
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018582One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18583provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18584very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18585provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18586state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018587to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018588headers.
18589
18590In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18591about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18592send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18593
18594 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18595 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18596 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18597 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18598 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018599 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018600 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018601
18602The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18603allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18604as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18605while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18606real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18607delay.
18608
18609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186108.1. Log levels
18611---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018612
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018613TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018614source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018615HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18616in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18617track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18618syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18619about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018620
18621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186228.2. Log formats
18623----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018624
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018625HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018626and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18627slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18628options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018629
18630 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18631 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18632 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18633 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18634 extents.
18635
18636 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18637 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18638 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18639 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18640 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18641
18642 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18643 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18644 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18645 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18646 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18647
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018648 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18649 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18650 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18651 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18652
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018653 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18654
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018655Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18656specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18657field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18658servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18659always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18660identifier.
18661
18662Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18663 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18664 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18665 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18666 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18667
18668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186698.2.1. Default log format
18670-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018671
18672This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18673as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18674format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18675
18676 Example :
18677 listen www
18678 mode http
18679 log global
18680 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18681
18682 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18683 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18684 (www/HTTP)
18685
18686 Field Format Extract from the example above
18687 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18688 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18689 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18690 4 'to' to
18691 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18692 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18693
18694Detailed fields description :
18695 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18696 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18697 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18698 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18699 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18700 and processed the connection.
18701 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18702
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018703In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18704"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18705connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18706
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018707It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18708will eventually disappear.
18709
18710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187118.2.2. TCP log format
18712---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018713
18714The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18715is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18716information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18717counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18718emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18719environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18720the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18721sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018722specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18723not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18724fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18725marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018726
18727 Example :
18728 frontend fnt
18729 mode tcp
18730 option tcplog
18731 log global
18732 default_backend bck
18733
18734 backend bck
18735 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18736
18737 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18738 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18739 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18740
18741 Field Format Extract from the example above
18742 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18743 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18744 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18745 4 frontend_name fnt
18746 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18747 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18748 7 bytes_read* 212
18749 8 termination_state --
18750 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18751 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18752
18753Detailed fields description :
18754 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018755 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18756 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18757 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018758 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018759 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018760 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018761
18762 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018763 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18764 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18765 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018766
18767 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18768 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18769 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018770 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18771 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18772 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18773 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018774
18775 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18776 and processed the connection.
18777
18778 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18779 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18780 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18781 applications.
18782
18783 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18784 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18785 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18786 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18787 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18788
18789 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18790 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18791 See "Timers" below for more details.
18792
18793 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18794 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18795 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18796 "Timers" below for more details.
18797
18798 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018799 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018800 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18801 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18802 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18803 details.
18804
18805 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18806 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18807 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18808 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18809 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18810
18811 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18812 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18813 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18814 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18815 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18816 for more details.
18817
18818 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018819 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018820 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18821 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18822 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018823 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018824
18825 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18826 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18827 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18828 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18829 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18830 caused by a denial of service attack.
18831
18832 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18833 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18834 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18835 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18836 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18837 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18838 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18839 denial of service attack.
18840
18841 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18842 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18843 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18844 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18845 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18846 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18847 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18848 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18849 be processed than on other servers.
18850
18851 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18852 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18853 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18854 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18855 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18856 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18857 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18858 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18859 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18860 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18861 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18862 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18863 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18864
18865 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18866 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18867 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18868 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18869 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18870 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018871 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018872 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18873
18874 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18875 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18876 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18877 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18878 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18879 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018880 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018881 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18882 occurs.
18883
18884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188858.2.3. HTTP log format
18886----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018887
18888The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18889is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18890the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18891are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18892emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18893generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18894"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18895which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018896frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18897is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018898
18899Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18900slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18901with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18902
18903 Example :
18904 frontend http-in
18905 mode http
18906 option httplog
18907 log global
18908 default_backend bck
18909
18910 backend static
18911 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18912
18913 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18914 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18915 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018916 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018917
18918 Field Format Extract from the example above
18919 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18920 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018921 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018922 4 frontend_name http-in
18923 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018924 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018925 7 status_code 200
18926 8 bytes_read* 2750
18927 9 captured_request_cookie -
18928 10 captured_response_cookie -
18929 11 termination_state ----
18930 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18931 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18932 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18933 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18934 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018936Detailed fields description :
18937 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018938 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18939 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18940 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018941 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018942 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018943 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018944
18945 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018946 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18947 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18948 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018949
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018950 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18951 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018952
18953 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18954 and processed the connection.
18955
18956 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18957 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18958 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18959
18960 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18961 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18962 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18963 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18964 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18965 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18966
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018967 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18968 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18969 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018970 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018971 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18972 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018973 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18974 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018975
18976 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18977 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018978 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018979
18980 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18981 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018982 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18983 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018984
18985 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18986 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18987 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18988 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18989 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018990 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18991 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018992
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018993 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18994 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18995 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18996 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18997 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18998 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18999 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019000 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019001
19002 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19003 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19004 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19005
19006 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19007 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019008 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019009 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19010 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19011 overflowing.
19012
19013 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19014 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19015 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19016 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19017 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19018 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19019 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19020 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19021
19022 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19023 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19024 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19025 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19026 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19027 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19028 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19029 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19030
19031 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19032 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19033 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19034 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19035 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19036 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19037 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19038
19039 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019040 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019041 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19042 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19043 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019044 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019045 system.
19046
19047 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19048 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19049 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19050 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19051 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19052 caused by a denial of service attack.
19053
19054 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19055 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19056 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19057 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19058 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19059 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19060 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19061 denial of service attack.
19062
19063 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19064 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19065 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19066 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19067 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19068 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19069 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19070 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19071 processed than on other servers.
19072
19073 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19074 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19075 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19076 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19077 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19078 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19079 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19080 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19081 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19082 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19083 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19084 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19085 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19086
19087 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19088 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19089 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19090 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19091 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19092 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019093 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019094 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19095
19096 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19097 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19098 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19099 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19100 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19101 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019102 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019103 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19104 occurs.
19105
19106 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19107 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19108 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19109 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19110 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19111 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19112 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19113 cookies" below for more details.
19114
19115 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19116 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19117 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19118 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19119 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19120 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19121 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19122 and cookies" below for more details.
19123
19124 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19125 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19126 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19127 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19128 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19129 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19130 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19131 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19132
19133
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200191348.2.4. Custom log format
19135------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019136
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019137The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019138mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019140HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019141Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19142separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19143prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19144
19145Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19146variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019147("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019148
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019149If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019150as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019151less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19152the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19153
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019154Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19155"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19156delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19157preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019158
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019159Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19160'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19161https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19162such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19163
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019164Flags are :
19165 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019166 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019167 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19168 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019169
19170 Example:
19171
19172 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19173 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19174
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019175 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19176
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019177At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19178
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019179 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19180 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019181
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019182the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019183
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019184 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19185 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19186 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019187
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019188and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19189
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019190 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19191 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019192
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019193Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19194
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019195 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019196 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019197 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19198 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19199 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019200 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19201 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19202 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019203 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019204 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19205 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019206 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019207 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19208 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019209 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019210 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019211 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019212 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019213 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019214 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019215 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019216 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19217 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19218 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19219 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19220 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019221 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019222 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019223 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019224 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019225 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019226 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19227 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019228 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19229 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19230 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019231 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019232 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19233 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019234 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019235 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19236 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19237 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019238 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019239 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019240 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19241 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19242 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19243 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019244 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019245 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019246 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019247 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019248 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019249 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019250 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19251 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19252 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019253 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019254 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19255 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019256 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019257 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19258 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019259 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019260 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019261 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019262 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019263
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019264 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019265
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019266
192678.2.5. Error log format
19268-----------------------
19269
19270When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19271protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19272By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19273"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019274will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019275logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19276
19277The format looks like this :
19278
19279 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19280 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19281 Connection error during SSL handshake
19282
19283 Field Format Extract from the example above
19284 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19285 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19286 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19287 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19288 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19289
19290These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19291failures.
19292
19293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192948.3. Advanced logging options
19295-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019296
19297Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19298just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19299options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19300for more information about their usage.
19301
19302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19304------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019305
19306It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19307haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19308commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19309monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19310ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19311
19312 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19313 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19314 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19315 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19316
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019317 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19318 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019319
19320 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19321 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19322 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19323
19324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193258.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19326----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019327
19328The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19329what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19330or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019331"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019332just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19333log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19334after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19335is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19336with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19337with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19338
19339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193408.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19341------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019342
19343Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19344for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19345"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19346retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19347raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19348a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19349file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19350you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19351"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19352
19353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193548.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19355--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019356
19357Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19358multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19359them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19360"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19361logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19362error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19363and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19364too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19365useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19366alternative.
19367
19368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193698.4. Timing events
19370------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019371
19372Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19373reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19374the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19375frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019376mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19377addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19378
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019379Timings events in HTTP mode:
19380
19381 first request 2nd request
19382 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19383 t tr t tr ...
19384 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19385 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19386 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19387 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019388 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019389 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19390
19391Timings events in TCP mode:
19392
19393 TCP session
19394 |<----------------->|
19395 t t
19396 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19397 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19398 |<------ Tt ------->|
19399
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019400 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019401 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019402 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19403 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19404 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019405 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019406 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19407 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19408 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19409 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019410
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019411 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19412 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19413 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019414 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19415 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19416 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19417 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19418 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19419 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019420
19421 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19422 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19423 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19424 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19425 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19426 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19427 request typed by hand during a test.
19428
19429 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19430 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019431 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019432 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19433 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19434 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19435 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019436
19437 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19438 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19439 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19440 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19441 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19442
19443 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19444 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19445 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19446 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19447 connection never established.
19448
19449 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19450 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19451 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19452 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19453 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19454 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19455 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19456 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19457 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19458 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19459 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19460
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019461 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19462 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19463 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19464 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19465 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19466 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19467
19468 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19469
19470 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19471 "Ta" can never be negative.
19472
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019473 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19474 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019475 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19476 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019477 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019478
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019479 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019480
19481 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019482 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19483 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019484
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019485 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19486 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19487 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19488 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19489 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19490 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19491 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19492 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19493
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019494These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19495protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19496that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019497due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19498"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19499that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019500
19501Most common cases :
19502
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019503 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19504 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19505 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19506 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19507 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19508 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19509 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19510 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19511 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19512 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19513 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019514 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019515
19516 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19517 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19518 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19519 of ms on remote networks.
19520
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019521 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19522 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19523 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019524
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019525 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19526 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19527 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19528 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19529 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19530 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19531 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19532 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19533 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019534
19535Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19536
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019537 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019538 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019539 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019540
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019541 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019542 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19543 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19544
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019545 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019546 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19547 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19548 flags.
19549
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019550 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19551 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019552 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19553 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19554 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19555 the client connection was maintained open.
19556
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019557 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019558 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019559 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019560 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19561
19562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195638.5. Session state at disconnection
19564-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019565
19566TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19567"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195682-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19569each of which has a special meaning :
19570
19571 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19572 session to terminate :
19573
19574 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19575
19576 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19577 server explicitly refused it.
19578
19579 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19580 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19581 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19582 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019583 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019584
19585 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19586 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019587
19588 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19589 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19590 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19591 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19592 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19593
19594 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19595 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19596 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19597 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19598 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19599
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019600 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19601 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19602
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019603 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19604 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19605 backup connections when going up.
19606
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019607 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19608
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019609 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19610 send or receive data.
19611
19612 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19613 send or receive data.
19614
19615 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19616 with nothing left in the buffers.
19617
19618 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19619
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019620 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019621 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19622
19623 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19624 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19625 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19626 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19627 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19628
19629 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19630 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19631
19632 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19633 server (HTTP only).
19634
19635 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19636
19637 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19638 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19639 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19640
19641 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19642 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19643 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19644
19645 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19646
19647 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19648 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19649
19650 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19651 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19652 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19653
19654 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19655 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019656 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19657 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019658
19659 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19660 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19661 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19662 another server.
19663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019664 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019665 server.
19666
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019667 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19668 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19669 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19670 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19671
19672 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19673 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19674 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19675 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19676
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019677 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19678 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19679 "use-server" rule).
19680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019681 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19682
19683 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19684 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19685
19686 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19687
19688 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19689 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19690 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19691
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019692 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19693 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019694 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019695 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19696 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019698 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19699
19700 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19701 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19702
19703 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19704
19705 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19706
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019707The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19708was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019709helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19710starvation, attacks, etc...
19711
19712The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19713alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19714easier finding and understanding.
19715
19716 Flags Reason
19717
19718 -- Normal termination.
19719
19720 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19721 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19722 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19723 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19724
19725 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19726 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19727 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19728 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19729 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19730 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019731
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019732 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19733 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019734 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019735
19736 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19737 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19738 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19739
19740 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19741 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19742 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19743 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19744 the server takes too long to respond.
19745
19746 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19747 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19748 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19749 long a time to respond.
19750
19751 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19752 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19753 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19754 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019755 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19756 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019757
19758 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19759 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19760 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19761 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19762 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019763 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019764 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19765 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19766 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19767 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19768 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19769 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19770 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19771 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019772 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019773 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19774 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19775 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019776
19777 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19778 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019779 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19780 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19781 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19782 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019783
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019784 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19785 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019787 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019788 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19789 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019790 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019791 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19792 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19793
19794 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19795 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19796 503 or 504 here.
19797
19798 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19799 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19800 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19801 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19802 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19803
19804 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19805 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019806 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019807 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19808 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19809
19810 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19811 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19812 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19813 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19814 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19815 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19816 between haproxy and the server.
19817
19818 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19819 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19820 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19821 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19822 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19823 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19824 solution is to fix the application.
19825
19826 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19827 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19828 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19829 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19830 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19831 external attacks.
19832
19833 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19834 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019835 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019836 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19837 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19838
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019839 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19840 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19841 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019842 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019843 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019844
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019845 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19846 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19847 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19848 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019849 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19850 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19851 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19852 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19853 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019854
19855 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19856 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19857 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19858 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19859
19860 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19861 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19862 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19863 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19864
19865 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19866 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19867 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19868 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19869
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019870The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19871persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19872important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19873re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19874
19875 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19876
19877 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19878 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19879 set on a GET request.
19880
19881 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19882 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019883 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019884 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19885
19886 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19887 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19888 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19889
19890 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19891 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19892 already got a cookie.
19893
19894 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19895 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19896 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19897 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19898 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19899
19900 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19901 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19902 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19903
19904 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19905 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19906 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19907
19908 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19909 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19910
19911 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19912 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19913 then advertised in the response.
19914
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199168.6. Non-printable characters
19917-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019918
19919In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19920consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19921converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19922prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19923being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19924escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19925is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19926'}' when logging headers.
19927
19928Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19929issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19930containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19931
19932Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19933the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19934performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19935
19936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199378.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19938---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019939
19940Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19941achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019942section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019943cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19944the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19945the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019946locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019947not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19948user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19949a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19950wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19951
19952 Examples :
19953 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19954 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19955
19956 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19957 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19958
19959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199608.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19961---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019962
19963Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19964proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19965the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19966server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19967
19968Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19969response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019970section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971
19972It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019973time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19974appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019975are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19976and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19977follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19978request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19979in the logs.
19980
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019981As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19982frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19983an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019985 Example :
19986 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19987 listen proxy-out
19988 mode http
19989 option httplog
19990 option logasap
19991 log global
19992 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19993
19994 # log the name of the virtual server
19995 capture request header Host len 20
19996
19997 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19998 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19999
20000 # log the beginning of the referrer
20001 capture request header Referer len 20
20002
20003 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20004 capture response header Server len 20
20005
20006 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20007 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20008
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020009 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020010 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20011
20012 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20013 capture response header Via len 20
20014
20015 # log the URL location during a redirection
20016 capture response header Location len 20
20017
20018 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20019 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20020 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20021 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20022 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20023
20024 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20025 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20026 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20027 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020028 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020029
20030 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20031 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20032 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20033 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20034 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020035 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020036
20037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200388.9. Examples of logs
20039---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020040
20041These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20042them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20043reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20044
20045 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20046 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20047 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20048
20049 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20050 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20051
20052 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20053 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20054 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20055
20056 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20057 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20058
20059 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20060 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20061 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20062
20063 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020064 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20066 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20067
20068 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20069 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20070 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20071
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020072 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20073 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20074 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20075 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20076 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20077 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020078
20079 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020080 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020081
20082 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20083 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20084 Nothing was sent to any server.
20085
20086 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20087 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20088
20089 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20090 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020091 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020092 send a 408 return code to the client.
20093
20094 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20095 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20096
20097 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20098 5 seconds ("c----").
20099
20100 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20101 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020102 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020103
20104 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020105 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020106 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20107 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20108 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20109 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20110 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020111
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200201139. Supported filters
20114--------------------
20115
20116Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20117accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20118unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20119
20120See also : "filter"
20121
201229.1. Trace
20123----------
20124
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020125filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020126
20127 Arguments:
20128 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20129 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20130
20131 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20132 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20133 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20134 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020136 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020137 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20138 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20139 amount of the parsed data.
20140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020141 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020142
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020143This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20144callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20145information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20146filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20147
20148Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20149tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20150a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20151
20152
201539.2. HTTP compression
20154---------------------
20155
20156filter compression
20157
20158The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20159keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020160when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20161fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20162done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20163explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20164filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20165listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20166order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020167
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020168See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20169 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020170
20171
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201729.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20173--------------------------------------------
20174
20175filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20176
20177 Arguments :
20178
20179 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20180 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20181 parsed.
20182
20183 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20184 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20185 part must be placed in its own scope.
20186
20187The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20188external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020189streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020190exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20191also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20192
20193SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20194the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20195
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020196For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020197"doc/SPOE.txt".
20198
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201999.4. Cache
20200----------
20201
20202filter cache <name>
20203
20204 Arguments :
20205
20206 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20207
20208The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20209"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020210cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020211other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20212case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20213is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20214filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020215listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20216order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020217
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020218See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20219 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20220
20221
202229.5. Fcgi-app
20223-------------
20224
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020225filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020226
20227 Arguments :
20228
20229 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20230
20231The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20232request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20233reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20234used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20235implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20236used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20237fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20238used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20239order.
20240
20241See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20242 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20243
20244
2024510. FastCGI applications
20246-------------------------
20247
20248HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20249feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20250the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20251FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20252servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20253FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20254backend.
20255
20256HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20257application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20258connection.
20259
2026010.1. Setup
20261-----------
20262
2026310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20264--------------------------
20265
20266fcgi-app <name>
20267 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20268 document root must be defined.
20269
20270acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20271 Declare or complete an access list.
20272
20273 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20274 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20275 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20276 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20277 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20278
20279docroot <path>
20280 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20281 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20282 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20283
20284index <script-name>
20285 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20286 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20287 is an optional setting.
20288
20289 Example :
20290 index index.php
20291
20292log-stderr global
20293log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20294 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20295 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20296
20297 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20298 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20299
20300pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20301 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20302 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20303 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20304
20305 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20306 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20307 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20308 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20309
20310 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20311 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20312
20313path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020314 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020315 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20316 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20317 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20318 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20319 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20320 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20321 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020322
20323 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020324 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020325 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20326 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20327 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20328 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020329
20330 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020331 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20332 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020333
20334option get-values
20335no option get-values
20336 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20337
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020338 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020339 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20340
20341 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20342 application will accept.
20343
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020344 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20345 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020346
20347 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020348 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020349 option is disabled.
20350
20351 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20352 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20353 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20354 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20355 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20356 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20357
20358option keep-conn
20359no option keep-conn
20360 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20361 sending a response.
20362
20363 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20364 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20365
20366option max-reqs <reqs>
20367 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20368 accept.
20369
20370 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20371 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20372 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20373 to 1.
20374
20375option mpxs-conns
20376no option mpxs-conns
20377 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20378
20379 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20380 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20381
20382set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20383 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20384 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20385 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20386 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20387
20388 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20389 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20390 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20391
20392 Example :
20393 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20394 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20395
20396 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20397
20398
2039910.1.2. Proxy section
20400---------------------
20401
20402use-fcgi-app <name>
20403 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20404
20405 Arguments :
20406 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20407
20408 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20409 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20410 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20411 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20412 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20413
20414 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20415 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20416 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20417 application are evaluated.
20418
20419
2042010.1.3. Example
20421---------------
20422
20423 frontend front-http
20424 mode http
20425 bind *:80
20426 bind *:
20427
20428 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20429 default_backend back-static
20430
20431 backend back-static
20432 mode http
20433 server www A.B.C.D:80
20434
20435 backend back-dynamic
20436 mode http
20437 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20438 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20439
20440 fcgi-app php-fpm
20441 log-stderr global
20442 option keep-conn
20443
20444 docroot /var/www/my-app
20445 index index.php
20446 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20447
20448
2044910.2. Default parameters
20450------------------------
20451
20452A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20453the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020454script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020455applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20456
20457 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20458 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20459 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20460 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20461 | | |
20462 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20463 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20464 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20465 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20466 | | application. |
20467 | | |
20468 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20469 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20470 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20471 | | |
20472 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20473 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20474 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20475 | | the application's configuration. |
20476 | | |
20477 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20478 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20479 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20480 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20481 | | |
20482 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20483 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20484 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20485 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20486 | | be defined. |
20487 | | |
20488 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20489 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20490 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20491 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20492 | | is not set too. |
20493 | | |
20494 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20495 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20496 | | set. |
20497 | | |
20498 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20499 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20500 | | the request. |
20501 | | |
20502 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20503 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20504 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20505 | | |
20506 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20507 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20508 | | script to process the request. |
20509 | | |
20510 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20511 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20512 | | |
20513 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20514 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20515 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20516 | | |
20517 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20518 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20519 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20520 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20521 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20522 | | |
20523 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20524 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20525 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20526 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20527 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20528 | | side. |
20529 | | |
20530 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20531 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20532 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20533 | | connected to. |
20534 | | |
20535 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20536 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20537 | | |
20538 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20539 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20540 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20541 | | |
20542 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20543
20544
2054510.3. Limitations
20546------------------
20547
20548The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20549way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20550during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20551establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20552application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20553or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20554message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20555these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20556and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20557
20558Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20559request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20560requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20561
20562About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20563into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20564fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20565"http-request" ones.
20566
20567Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20568FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20569processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20570must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20571here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020573/*
20574 * Local variables:
20575 * fill-column: 79
20576 * End:
20577 */